xref: /vim-8.2.3635/src/misc1.c (revision cc7ff3fc)
1 /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4:
2  *
3  * VIM - Vi IMproved	by Bram Moolenaar
4  *
5  * Do ":help uganda"  in Vim to read copying and usage conditions.
6  * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed.
7  * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code.
8  */
9 
10 /*
11  * misc1.c: functions that didn't seem to fit elsewhere
12  */
13 
14 #include "vim.h"
15 #include "version.h"
16 
17 static char_u *vim_version_dir __ARGS((char_u *vimdir));
18 static char_u *remove_tail __ARGS((char_u *p, char_u *pend, char_u *name));
19 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL)
20 static void init_users __ARGS((void));
21 #endif
22 static int copy_indent __ARGS((int size, char_u	*src));
23 
24 /* All user names (for ~user completion as done by shell). */
25 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO)
26 static garray_T	ga_users;
27 #endif
28 
29 /*
30  * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in the current line.
31  */
32     int
33 get_indent()
34 {
35     return get_indent_str(ml_get_curline(), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE);
36 }
37 
38 /*
39  * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum".
40  */
41     int
42 get_indent_lnum(lnum)
43     linenr_T	lnum;
44 {
45     return get_indent_str(ml_get(lnum), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE);
46 }
47 
48 #if defined(FEAT_FOLDING) || defined(PROTO)
49 /*
50  * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum" of buffer
51  * "buf".
52  */
53     int
54 get_indent_buf(buf, lnum)
55     buf_T	*buf;
56     linenr_T	lnum;
57 {
58     return get_indent_str(ml_get_buf(buf, lnum, FALSE), (int)buf->b_p_ts, FALSE);
59 }
60 #endif
61 
62 /*
63  * count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "ptr", with
64  * 'tabstop' at "ts"
65  */
66     int
67 get_indent_str(ptr, ts, list)
68     char_u	*ptr;
69     int		ts;
70     int		list; /* if TRUE, count only screen size for tabs */
71 {
72     int		count = 0;
73 
74     for ( ; *ptr; ++ptr)
75     {
76 	if (*ptr == TAB)
77 	{
78 	    if (!list || lcs_tab1)    /* count a tab for what it is worth */
79 		count += ts - (count % ts);
80 	    else
81 		/* In list mode, when tab is not set, count screen char width
82 		 * for Tab, displays: ^I */
83 		count += ptr2cells(ptr);
84 	}
85 	else if (*ptr == ' ')
86 	    ++count;		/* count a space for one */
87 	else
88 	    break;
89     }
90     return count;
91 }
92 
93 /*
94  * Set the indent of the current line.
95  * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line.
96  * Caller must take care of undo.
97  * "flags":
98  *	SIN_CHANGED:	call changed_bytes() if the line was changed.
99  *	SIN_INSERT:	insert the indent in front of the line.
100  *	SIN_UNDO:	save line for undo before changing it.
101  * Returns TRUE if the line was changed.
102  */
103     int
104 set_indent(size, flags)
105     int		size;		    /* measured in spaces */
106     int		flags;
107 {
108     char_u	*p;
109     char_u	*newline;
110     char_u	*oldline;
111     char_u	*s;
112     int		todo;
113     int		ind_len;	    /* measured in characters */
114     int		line_len;
115     int		doit = FALSE;
116     int		ind_done = 0;	    /* measured in spaces */
117     int		tab_pad;
118     int		retval = FALSE;
119     int		orig_char_len = -1; /* number of initial whitespace chars when
120 				       'et' and 'pi' are both set */
121 
122     /*
123      * First check if there is anything to do and compute the number of
124      * characters needed for the indent.
125      */
126     todo = size;
127     ind_len = 0;
128     p = oldline = ml_get_curline();
129 
130     /* Calculate the buffer size for the new indent, and check to see if it
131      * isn't already set */
132 
133     /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs; if both 'expandtab' and
134      * 'preserveindent' are set count the number of characters at the
135      * beginning of the line to be copied */
136     if (!curbuf->b_p_et || (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi))
137     {
138 	/* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of
139 	 * the existing indent structure for the new indent */
140 	if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi)
141 	{
142 	    ind_done = 0;
143 
144 	    /* count as many characters as we can use */
145 	    while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p))
146 	    {
147 		if (*p == TAB)
148 		{
149 		    tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts
150 					   - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
151 		    /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */
152 		    if (todo < tab_pad)
153 			break;
154 		    todo -= tab_pad;
155 		    ++ind_len;
156 		    ind_done += tab_pad;
157 		}
158 		else
159 		{
160 		    --todo;
161 		    ++ind_len;
162 		    ++ind_done;
163 		}
164 		++p;
165 	    }
166 
167 	    /* Set initial number of whitespace chars to copy if we are
168 	     * preserving indent but expandtab is set */
169 	    if (curbuf->b_p_et)
170 		orig_char_len = ind_len;
171 
172 	    /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */
173 	    tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
174 	    if (todo >= tab_pad && orig_char_len == -1)
175 	    {
176 		doit = TRUE;
177 		todo -= tab_pad;
178 		++ind_len;
179 		/* ind_done += tab_pad; */
180 	    }
181 	}
182 
183 	/* count tabs required for indent */
184 	while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts)
185 	{
186 	    if (*p != TAB)
187 		doit = TRUE;
188 	    else
189 		++p;
190 	    todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts;
191 	    ++ind_len;
192 	    /* ind_done += (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; */
193 	}
194     }
195     /* count spaces required for indent */
196     while (todo > 0)
197     {
198 	if (*p != ' ')
199 	    doit = TRUE;
200 	else
201 	    ++p;
202 	--todo;
203 	++ind_len;
204 	/* ++ind_done; */
205     }
206 
207     /* Return if the indent is OK already. */
208     if (!doit && !vim_iswhite(*p) && !(flags & SIN_INSERT))
209 	return FALSE;
210 
211     /* Allocate memory for the new line. */
212     if (flags & SIN_INSERT)
213 	p = oldline;
214     else
215 	p = skipwhite(p);
216     line_len = (int)STRLEN(p) + 1;
217 
218     /* If 'preserveindent' and 'expandtab' are both set keep the original
219      * characters and allocate accordingly.  We will fill the rest with spaces
220      * after the if (!curbuf->b_p_et) below. */
221     if (orig_char_len != -1)
222     {
223 	newline = alloc(orig_char_len + size - ind_done + line_len);
224 	if (newline == NULL)
225 	    return FALSE;
226 	todo = size - ind_done;
227 	ind_len = orig_char_len + todo;    /* Set total length of indent in
228 					    * characters, which may have been
229 					    * undercounted until now  */
230 	p = oldline;
231 	s = newline;
232 	while (orig_char_len > 0)
233 	{
234 	    *s++ = *p++;
235 	    orig_char_len--;
236 	}
237 
238 	/* Skip over any additional white space (useful when newindent is less
239 	 * than old) */
240 	while (vim_iswhite(*p))
241 	    ++p;
242 
243     }
244     else
245     {
246 	todo = size;
247 	newline = alloc(ind_len + line_len);
248 	if (newline == NULL)
249 	    return FALSE;
250 	s = newline;
251     }
252 
253     /* Put the characters in the new line. */
254     /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs */
255     if (!curbuf->b_p_et)
256     {
257 	/* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of
258 	 * the existing indent structure for the new indent */
259 	if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi)
260 	{
261 	    p = oldline;
262 	    ind_done = 0;
263 
264 	    while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p))
265 	    {
266 		if (*p == TAB)
267 		{
268 		    tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts
269 					   - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
270 		    /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */
271 		    if (todo < tab_pad)
272 			break;
273 		    todo -= tab_pad;
274 		    ind_done += tab_pad;
275 		}
276 		else
277 		{
278 		    --todo;
279 		    ++ind_done;
280 		}
281 		*s++ = *p++;
282 	    }
283 
284 	    /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */
285 	    tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
286 	    if (todo >= tab_pad)
287 	    {
288 		*s++ = TAB;
289 		todo -= tab_pad;
290 	    }
291 
292 	    p = skipwhite(p);
293 	}
294 
295 	while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts)
296 	{
297 	    *s++ = TAB;
298 	    todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts;
299 	}
300     }
301     while (todo > 0)
302     {
303 	*s++ = ' ';
304 	--todo;
305     }
306     mch_memmove(s, p, (size_t)line_len);
307 
308     /* Replace the line (unless undo fails). */
309     if (!(flags & SIN_UNDO) || u_savesub(curwin->w_cursor.lnum) == OK)
310     {
311 	ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, newline, FALSE);
312 	if (flags & SIN_CHANGED)
313 	    changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0);
314 	/* Correct saved cursor position if it is in this line. */
315 	if (saved_cursor.lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum)
316 	{
317 	    if (saved_cursor.col >= (colnr_T)(p - oldline))
318 		/* cursor was after the indent, adjust for the number of
319 		 * bytes added/removed */
320 		saved_cursor.col += ind_len - (colnr_T)(p - oldline);
321 	    else if (saved_cursor.col >= (colnr_T)(s - newline))
322 		/* cursor was in the indent, and is now after it, put it back
323 		 * at the start of the indent (replacing spaces with TAB) */
324 		saved_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(s - newline);
325 	}
326 	retval = TRUE;
327     }
328     else
329 	vim_free(newline);
330 
331     curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len;
332     return retval;
333 }
334 
335 /*
336  * Copy the indent from ptr to the current line (and fill to size)
337  * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line.
338  * Returns TRUE if the line was changed.
339  */
340     static int
341 copy_indent(size, src)
342     int		size;
343     char_u	*src;
344 {
345     char_u	*p = NULL;
346     char_u	*line = NULL;
347     char_u	*s;
348     int		todo;
349     int		ind_len;
350     int		line_len = 0;
351     int		tab_pad;
352     int		ind_done;
353     int		round;
354 
355     /* Round 1: compute the number of characters needed for the indent
356      * Round 2: copy the characters. */
357     for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
358     {
359 	todo = size;
360 	ind_len = 0;
361 	ind_done = 0;
362 	s = src;
363 
364 	/* Count/copy the usable portion of the source line */
365 	while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*s))
366 	{
367 	    if (*s == TAB)
368 	    {
369 		tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts
370 					   - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
371 		/* Stop if this tab will overshoot the target */
372 		if (todo < tab_pad)
373 		    break;
374 		todo -= tab_pad;
375 		ind_done += tab_pad;
376 	    }
377 	    else
378 	    {
379 		--todo;
380 		++ind_done;
381 	    }
382 	    ++ind_len;
383 	    if (p != NULL)
384 		*p++ = *s;
385 	    ++s;
386 	}
387 
388 	/* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */
389 	tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts);
390 	if (todo >= tab_pad && !curbuf->b_p_et)
391 	{
392 	    todo -= tab_pad;
393 	    ++ind_len;
394 	    if (p != NULL)
395 		*p++ = TAB;
396 	}
397 
398 	/* Add tabs required for indent */
399 	while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts && !curbuf->b_p_et)
400 	{
401 	    todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts;
402 	    ++ind_len;
403 	    if (p != NULL)
404 		*p++ = TAB;
405 	}
406 
407 	/* Count/add spaces required for indent */
408 	while (todo > 0)
409 	{
410 	    --todo;
411 	    ++ind_len;
412 	    if (p != NULL)
413 		*p++ = ' ';
414 	}
415 
416 	if (p == NULL)
417 	{
418 	    /* Allocate memory for the result: the copied indent, new indent
419 	     * and the rest of the line. */
420 	    line_len = (int)STRLEN(ml_get_curline()) + 1;
421 	    line = alloc(ind_len + line_len);
422 	    if (line == NULL)
423 		return FALSE;
424 	    p = line;
425 	}
426     }
427 
428     /* Append the original line */
429     mch_memmove(p, ml_get_curline(), (size_t)line_len);
430 
431     /* Replace the line */
432     ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, line, FALSE);
433 
434     /* Put the cursor after the indent. */
435     curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len;
436     return TRUE;
437 }
438 
439 /*
440  * Return the indent of the current line after a number.  Return -1 if no
441  * number was found.  Used for 'n' in 'formatoptions': numbered list.
442  * Since a pattern is used it can actually handle more than numbers.
443  */
444     int
445 get_number_indent(lnum)
446     linenr_T	lnum;
447 {
448     colnr_T	col;
449     pos_T	pos;
450 
451     regmatch_T	regmatch;
452     int		lead_len = 0;	/* length of comment leader */
453 
454     if (lnum > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
455 	return -1;
456     pos.lnum = 0;
457 
458 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
459     /* In format_lines() (i.e. not insert mode), fo+=q is needed too...  */
460     if ((State & INSERT) || has_format_option(FO_Q_COMS))
461 	lead_len = get_leader_len(ml_get(lnum), NULL, FALSE, TRUE);
462 #endif
463     regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(curbuf->b_p_flp, RE_MAGIC);
464     if (regmatch.regprog != NULL)
465     {
466 	regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE;
467 
468 	/* vim_regexec() expects a pointer to a line.  This lets us
469 	 * start matching for the flp beyond any comment leader...  */
470 	if (vim_regexec(&regmatch, ml_get(lnum) + lead_len, (colnr_T)0))
471 	{
472 	    pos.lnum = lnum;
473 	    pos.col = (colnr_T)(*regmatch.endp - ml_get(lnum));
474 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
475 	    pos.coladd = 0;
476 #endif
477 	}
478 	vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog);
479     }
480 
481     if (pos.lnum == 0 || *ml_get_pos(&pos) == NUL)
482 	return -1;
483     getvcol(curwin, &pos, &col, NULL, NULL);
484     return (int)col;
485 }
486 
487 #if defined(FEAT_LINEBREAK) || defined(PROTO)
488 /*
489  * Return appropriate space number for breakindent, taking influencing
490  * parameters into account. Window must be specified, since it is not
491  * necessarily always the current one.
492  */
493     int
494 get_breakindent_win(wp, line)
495     win_T	*wp;
496     char_u	*line; /* start of the line */
497 {
498     static int	    prev_indent = 0;  /* cached indent value */
499     static long	    prev_ts     = 0L; /* cached tabstop value */
500     static char_u   *prev_line = NULL; /* cached pointer to line */
501     static int	    prev_tick = 0;   /* changedtick of cached value */
502     int		    bri = 0;
503     /* window width minus window margin space, i.e. what rests for text */
504     const int	    eff_wwidth = W_WIDTH(wp)
505 			    - ((wp->w_p_nu || wp->w_p_rnu)
506 				&& (vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_NUMCOL) == NULL)
507 						? number_width(wp) + 1 : 0);
508 
509     /* used cached indent, unless pointer or 'tabstop' changed */
510     if (prev_line != line || prev_ts != wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts
511 				  || prev_tick != wp->w_buffer->b_changedtick)
512     {
513 	prev_line = line;
514 	prev_ts = wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts;
515 	prev_tick = wp->w_buffer->b_changedtick;
516 	prev_indent = get_indent_str(line,
517 				     (int)wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts, wp->w_p_list);
518     }
519     bri = prev_indent + wp->w_p_brishift;
520 
521     /* indent minus the length of the showbreak string */
522     if (wp->w_p_brisbr)
523 	bri -= vim_strsize(p_sbr);
524 
525     /* Add offset for number column, if 'n' is in 'cpoptions' */
526     bri += win_col_off2(wp);
527 
528     /* never indent past left window margin */
529     if (bri < 0)
530 	bri = 0;
531     /* always leave at least bri_min characters on the left,
532      * if text width is sufficient */
533     else if (bri > eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin)
534 	bri = (eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin < 0)
535 			    ? 0 : eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin;
536 
537     return bri;
538 }
539 #endif
540 
541 
542 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT)
543 
544 static int cin_is_cinword __ARGS((char_u *line));
545 
546 /*
547  * Return TRUE if the string "line" starts with a word from 'cinwords'.
548  */
549     static int
550 cin_is_cinword(line)
551     char_u	*line;
552 {
553     char_u	*cinw;
554     char_u	*cinw_buf;
555     int		cinw_len;
556     int		retval = FALSE;
557     int		len;
558 
559     cinw_len = (int)STRLEN(curbuf->b_p_cinw) + 1;
560     cinw_buf = alloc((unsigned)cinw_len);
561     if (cinw_buf != NULL)
562     {
563 	line = skipwhite(line);
564 	for (cinw = curbuf->b_p_cinw; *cinw; )
565 	{
566 	    len = copy_option_part(&cinw, cinw_buf, cinw_len, ",");
567 	    if (STRNCMP(line, cinw_buf, len) == 0
568 		    && (!vim_iswordc(line[len]) || !vim_iswordc(line[len - 1])))
569 	    {
570 		retval = TRUE;
571 		break;
572 	    }
573 	}
574 	vim_free(cinw_buf);
575     }
576     return retval;
577 }
578 #endif
579 
580 /*
581  * open_line: Add a new line below or above the current line.
582  *
583  * For VREPLACE mode, we only add a new line when we get to the end of the
584  * file, otherwise we just start replacing the next line.
585  *
586  * Caller must take care of undo.  Since VREPLACE may affect any number of
587  * lines however, it may call u_save_cursor() again when starting to change a
588  * new line.
589  * "flags": OPENLINE_DELSPACES	delete spaces after cursor
590  *	    OPENLINE_DO_COM	format comments
591  *	    OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL	keep trailing spaces
592  *	    OPENLINE_MARKFIX	adjust mark positions after the line break
593  *	    OPENLINE_COM_LIST	format comments with list or 2nd line indent
594  *
595  * "second_line_indent": indent for after ^^D in Insert mode or if flag
596  *			  OPENLINE_COM_LIST
597  *
598  * Return TRUE for success, FALSE for failure
599  */
600     int
601 open_line(dir, flags, second_line_indent)
602     int		dir;		/* FORWARD or BACKWARD */
603     int		flags;
604     int		second_line_indent;
605 {
606     char_u	*saved_line;		/* copy of the original line */
607     char_u	*next_line = NULL;	/* copy of the next line */
608     char_u	*p_extra = NULL;	/* what goes to next line */
609     int		less_cols = 0;		/* less columns for mark in new line */
610     int		less_cols_off = 0;	/* columns to skip for mark adjust */
611     pos_T	old_cursor;		/* old cursor position */
612     int		newcol = 0;		/* new cursor column */
613     int		newindent = 0;		/* auto-indent of the new line */
614     int		n;
615     int		trunc_line = FALSE;	/* truncate current line afterwards */
616     int		retval = FALSE;		/* return value, default is FAIL */
617 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
618     int		extra_len = 0;		/* length of p_extra string */
619     int		lead_len;		/* length of comment leader */
620     char_u	*lead_flags;	/* position in 'comments' for comment leader */
621     char_u	*leader = NULL;		/* copy of comment leader */
622 #endif
623     char_u	*allocated = NULL;	/* allocated memory */
624 #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_LISP) \
625 	|| defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS)
626     char_u	*p;
627 #endif
628     int		saved_char = NUL;	/* init for GCC */
629 #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS)
630     pos_T	*pos;
631 #endif
632 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
633     int		do_si = (!p_paste && curbuf->b_p_si
634 # ifdef FEAT_CINDENT
635 					&& !curbuf->b_p_cin
636 # endif
637 			);
638     int		no_si = FALSE;		/* reset did_si afterwards */
639     int		first_char = NUL;	/* init for GCC */
640 #endif
641 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT))
642     int		vreplace_mode;
643 #endif
644     int		did_append;		/* appended a new line */
645     int		saved_pi = curbuf->b_p_pi; /* copy of preserveindent setting */
646 
647     /*
648      * make a copy of the current line so we can mess with it
649      */
650     saved_line = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline());
651     if (saved_line == NULL)	    /* out of memory! */
652 	return FALSE;
653 
654 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
655     if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG)
656     {
657 	/*
658 	 * With VREPLACE we make a copy of the next line, which we will be
659 	 * starting to replace.  First make the new line empty and let vim play
660 	 * with the indenting and comment leader to its heart's content.  Then
661 	 * we grab what it ended up putting on the new line, put back the
662 	 * original line, and call ins_char() to put each new character onto
663 	 * the line, replacing what was there before and pushing the right
664 	 * stuff onto the replace stack.  -- webb.
665 	 */
666 	if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum < orig_line_count)
667 	    next_line = vim_strsave(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1));
668 	else
669 	    next_line = vim_strsave((char_u *)"");
670 	if (next_line == NULL)	    /* out of memory! */
671 	    goto theend;
672 
673 	/*
674 	 * In VREPLACE mode, a NL replaces the rest of the line, and starts
675 	 * replacing the next line, so push all of the characters left on the
676 	 * line onto the replace stack.  We'll push any other characters that
677 	 * might be replaced at the start of the next line (due to autoindent
678 	 * etc) a bit later.
679 	 */
680 	replace_push(NUL);  /* Call twice because BS over NL expects it */
681 	replace_push(NUL);
682 	p = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col;
683 	while (*p != NUL)
684 	{
685 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
686 	    if (has_mbyte)
687 		p += replace_push_mb(p);
688 	    else
689 #endif
690 		replace_push(*p++);
691 	}
692 	saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL;
693     }
694 #endif
695 
696     if ((State & INSERT)
697 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
698 	    && !(State & VREPLACE_FLAG)
699 #endif
700 	    )
701     {
702 	p_extra = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col;
703 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
704 	if (do_si)		/* need first char after new line break */
705 	{
706 	    p = skipwhite(p_extra);
707 	    first_char = *p;
708 	}
709 #endif
710 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
711 	extra_len = (int)STRLEN(p_extra);
712 #endif
713 	saved_char = *p_extra;
714 	*p_extra = NUL;
715     }
716 
717     u_clearline();		/* cannot do "U" command when adding lines */
718 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
719     did_si = FALSE;
720 #endif
721     ai_col = 0;
722 
723     /*
724      * If we just did an auto-indent, then we didn't type anything on
725      * the prior line, and it should be truncated.  Do this even if 'ai' is not
726      * set because automatically inserting a comment leader also sets did_ai.
727      */
728     if (dir == FORWARD && did_ai)
729 	trunc_line = TRUE;
730 
731     /*
732      * If 'autoindent' and/or 'smartindent' is set, try to figure out what
733      * indent to use for the new line.
734      */
735     if (curbuf->b_p_ai
736 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
737 			|| do_si
738 #endif
739 					    )
740     {
741 	/*
742 	 * count white space on current line
743 	 */
744 	newindent = get_indent_str(saved_line, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE);
745 	if (newindent == 0 && !(flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST))
746 	    newindent = second_line_indent; /* for ^^D command in insert mode */
747 
748 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
749 	/*
750 	 * Do smart indenting.
751 	 * In insert/replace mode (only when dir == FORWARD)
752 	 * we may move some text to the next line. If it starts with '{'
753 	 * don't add an indent. Fixes inserting a NL before '{' in line
754 	 *	"if (condition) {"
755 	 */
756 	if (!trunc_line && do_si && *saved_line != NUL
757 				    && (p_extra == NULL || first_char != '{'))
758 	{
759 	    char_u  *ptr;
760 	    char_u  last_char;
761 
762 	    old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor;
763 	    ptr = saved_line;
764 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
765 	    if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM)
766 		lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE);
767 	    else
768 		lead_len = 0;
769 # endif
770 	    if (dir == FORWARD)
771 	    {
772 		/*
773 		 * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are
774 		 * recognised as comments.
775 		 */
776 		if (
777 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
778 			lead_len == 0 &&
779 # endif
780 			ptr[0] == '#')
781 		{
782 		    while (ptr[0] == '#' && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
783 			ptr = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum);
784 		    newindent = get_indent();
785 		}
786 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
787 		if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM)
788 		    lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE);
789 		else
790 		    lead_len = 0;
791 		if (lead_len > 0)
792 		{
793 		    /*
794 		     * This case gets the following right:
795 		     *	    \*
796 		     *	     * A comment (read '\' as '/').
797 		     *	     *\
798 		     * #define IN_THE_WAY
799 		     *	    This should line up here;
800 		     */
801 		    p = skipwhite(ptr);
802 		    if (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '*')
803 			p++;
804 		    if (p[0] == '*')
805 		    {
806 			for (p++; *p; p++)
807 			{
808 			    if (p[0] == '/' && p[-1] == '*')
809 			    {
810 				/*
811 				 * End of C comment, indent should line up
812 				 * with the line containing the start of
813 				 * the comment
814 				 */
815 				curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr);
816 				if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL)
817 				{
818 				    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum;
819 				    newindent = get_indent();
820 				}
821 			    }
822 			}
823 		    }
824 		}
825 		else	/* Not a comment line */
826 # endif
827 		{
828 		    /* Find last non-blank in line */
829 		    p = ptr + STRLEN(ptr) - 1;
830 		    while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p))
831 			--p;
832 		    last_char = *p;
833 
834 		    /*
835 		     * find the character just before the '{' or ';'
836 		     */
837 		    if (last_char == '{' || last_char == ';')
838 		    {
839 			if (p > ptr)
840 			    --p;
841 			while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p))
842 			    --p;
843 		    }
844 		    /*
845 		     * Try to catch lines that are split over multiple
846 		     * lines.  eg:
847 		     *	    if (condition &&
848 		     *			condition) {
849 		     *		Should line up here!
850 		     *	    }
851 		     */
852 		    if (*p == ')')
853 		    {
854 			curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr);
855 			if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) != NULL)
856 			{
857 			    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum;
858 			    newindent = get_indent();
859 			    ptr = ml_get_curline();
860 			}
861 		    }
862 		    /*
863 		     * If last character is '{' do indent, without
864 		     * checking for "if" and the like.
865 		     */
866 		    if (last_char == '{')
867 		    {
868 			did_si = TRUE;	/* do indent */
869 			no_si = TRUE;	/* don't delete it when '{' typed */
870 		    }
871 		    /*
872 		     * Look for "if" and the like, use 'cinwords'.
873 		     * Don't do this if the previous line ended in ';' or
874 		     * '}'.
875 		     */
876 		    else if (last_char != ';' && last_char != '}'
877 						       && cin_is_cinword(ptr))
878 			did_si = TRUE;
879 		}
880 	    }
881 	    else /* dir == BACKWARD */
882 	    {
883 		/*
884 		 * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are
885 		 * recognised as comments.
886 		 */
887 		if (
888 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
889 			lead_len == 0 &&
890 # endif
891 			ptr[0] == '#')
892 		{
893 		    int was_backslashed = FALSE;
894 
895 		    while ((ptr[0] == '#' || was_backslashed) &&
896 			 curwin->w_cursor.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
897 		    {
898 			if (*ptr && ptr[STRLEN(ptr) - 1] == '\\')
899 			    was_backslashed = TRUE;
900 			else
901 			    was_backslashed = FALSE;
902 			ptr = ml_get(++curwin->w_cursor.lnum);
903 		    }
904 		    if (was_backslashed)
905 			newindent = 0;	    /* Got to end of file */
906 		    else
907 			newindent = get_indent();
908 		}
909 		p = skipwhite(ptr);
910 		if (*p == '}')	    /* if line starts with '}': do indent */
911 		    did_si = TRUE;
912 		else		    /* can delete indent when '{' typed */
913 		    can_si_back = TRUE;
914 	    }
915 	    curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor;
916 	}
917 	if (do_si)
918 	    can_si = TRUE;
919 #endif /* FEAT_SMARTINDENT */
920 
921 	did_ai = TRUE;
922     }
923 
924 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
925     /*
926      * Find out if the current line starts with a comment leader.
927      * This may then be inserted in front of the new line.
928      */
929     end_comment_pending = NUL;
930     if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM)
931 	lead_len = get_leader_len(saved_line, &lead_flags, dir == BACKWARD, TRUE);
932     else
933 	lead_len = 0;
934     if (lead_len > 0)
935     {
936 	char_u	*lead_repl = NULL;	    /* replaces comment leader */
937 	int	lead_repl_len = 0;	    /* length of *lead_repl */
938 	char_u	lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN];   /* middle-comment string */
939 	char_u	lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN];	    /* end-comment string */
940 	char_u	*comment_end = NULL;	    /* where lead_end has been found */
941 	int	extra_space = FALSE;	    /* append extra space */
942 	int	current_flag;
943 	int	require_blank = FALSE;	    /* requires blank after middle */
944 	char_u	*p2;
945 
946 	/*
947 	 * If the comment leader has the start, middle or end flag, it may not
948 	 * be used or may be replaced with the middle leader.
949 	 */
950 	for (p = lead_flags; *p && *p != ':'; ++p)
951 	{
952 	    if (*p == COM_BLANK)
953 	    {
954 		require_blank = TRUE;
955 		continue;
956 	    }
957 	    if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_MIDDLE)
958 	    {
959 		current_flag = *p;
960 		if (*p == COM_START)
961 		{
962 		    /*
963 		     * Doing "O" on a start of comment does not insert leader.
964 		     */
965 		    if (dir == BACKWARD)
966 		    {
967 			lead_len = 0;
968 			break;
969 		    }
970 
971 		    /* find start of middle part */
972 		    (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
973 		    require_blank = FALSE;
974 		}
975 
976 		/*
977 		 * Isolate the strings of the middle and end leader.
978 		 */
979 		while (*p && p[-1] != ':')	/* find end of middle flags */
980 		{
981 		    if (*p == COM_BLANK)
982 			require_blank = TRUE;
983 		    ++p;
984 		}
985 		(void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
986 
987 		while (*p && p[-1] != ':')	/* find end of end flags */
988 		{
989 		    /* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */
990 		    if (*p == COM_AUTO_END)
991 			end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */
992 		    ++p;
993 		}
994 		n = copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
995 
996 		if (end_comment_pending == -1)	/* we can set it now */
997 		    end_comment_pending = lead_end[n - 1];
998 
999 		/*
1000 		 * If the end of the comment is in the same line, don't use
1001 		 * the comment leader.
1002 		 */
1003 		if (dir == FORWARD)
1004 		{
1005 		    for (p = saved_line + lead_len; *p; ++p)
1006 			if (STRNCMP(p, lead_end, n) == 0)
1007 			{
1008 			    comment_end = p;
1009 			    lead_len = 0;
1010 			    break;
1011 			}
1012 		}
1013 
1014 		/*
1015 		 * Doing "o" on a start of comment inserts the middle leader.
1016 		 */
1017 		if (lead_len > 0)
1018 		{
1019 		    if (current_flag == COM_START)
1020 		    {
1021 			lead_repl = lead_middle;
1022 			lead_repl_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle);
1023 		    }
1024 
1025 		    /*
1026 		     * If we have hit RETURN immediately after the start
1027 		     * comment leader, then put a space after the middle
1028 		     * comment leader on the next line.
1029 		     */
1030 		    if (!vim_iswhite(saved_line[lead_len - 1])
1031 			    && ((p_extra != NULL
1032 				    && (int)curwin->w_cursor.col == lead_len)
1033 				|| (p_extra == NULL
1034 				    && saved_line[lead_len] == NUL)
1035 				|| require_blank))
1036 			extra_space = TRUE;
1037 		}
1038 		break;
1039 	    }
1040 	    if (*p == COM_END)
1041 	    {
1042 		/*
1043 		 * Doing "o" on the end of a comment does not insert leader.
1044 		 * Remember where the end is, might want to use it to find the
1045 		 * start (for C-comments).
1046 		 */
1047 		if (dir == FORWARD)
1048 		{
1049 		    comment_end = skipwhite(saved_line);
1050 		    lead_len = 0;
1051 		    break;
1052 		}
1053 
1054 		/*
1055 		 * Doing "O" on the end of a comment inserts the middle leader.
1056 		 * Find the string for the middle leader, searching backwards.
1057 		 */
1058 		while (p > curbuf->b_p_com && *p != ',')
1059 		    --p;
1060 		for (lead_repl = p; lead_repl > curbuf->b_p_com
1061 					 && lead_repl[-1] != ':'; --lead_repl)
1062 		    ;
1063 		lead_repl_len = (int)(p - lead_repl);
1064 
1065 		/* We can probably always add an extra space when doing "O" on
1066 		 * the comment-end */
1067 		extra_space = TRUE;
1068 
1069 		/* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */
1070 		for (p2 = p; *p2 && *p2 != ':'; p2++)
1071 		{
1072 		    if (*p2 == COM_AUTO_END)
1073 			end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */
1074 		}
1075 		if (end_comment_pending == -1)
1076 		{
1077 		    /* Find last character in end-comment string */
1078 		    while (*p2 && *p2 != ',')
1079 			p2++;
1080 		    end_comment_pending = p2[-1];
1081 		}
1082 		break;
1083 	    }
1084 	    if (*p == COM_FIRST)
1085 	    {
1086 		/*
1087 		 * Comment leader for first line only:	Don't repeat leader
1088 		 * when using "O", blank out leader when using "o".
1089 		 */
1090 		if (dir == BACKWARD)
1091 		    lead_len = 0;
1092 		else
1093 		{
1094 		    lead_repl = (char_u *)"";
1095 		    lead_repl_len = 0;
1096 		}
1097 		break;
1098 	    }
1099 	}
1100 	if (lead_len)
1101 	{
1102 	    /* allocate buffer (may concatenate p_extra later) */
1103 	    leader = alloc(lead_len + lead_repl_len + extra_space + extra_len
1104 		     + (second_line_indent > 0 ? second_line_indent : 0) + 1);
1105 	    allocated = leader;		    /* remember to free it later */
1106 
1107 	    if (leader == NULL)
1108 		lead_len = 0;
1109 	    else
1110 	    {
1111 		vim_strncpy(leader, saved_line, lead_len);
1112 
1113 		/*
1114 		 * Replace leader with lead_repl, right or left adjusted
1115 		 */
1116 		if (lead_repl != NULL)
1117 		{
1118 		    int		c = 0;
1119 		    int		off = 0;
1120 
1121 		    for (p = lead_flags; *p != NUL && *p != ':'; )
1122 		    {
1123 			if (*p == COM_RIGHT || *p == COM_LEFT)
1124 			    c = *p++;
1125 			else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-')
1126 			    off = getdigits(&p);
1127 			else
1128 			    ++p;
1129 		    }
1130 		    if (c == COM_RIGHT)    /* right adjusted leader */
1131 		    {
1132 			/* find last non-white in the leader to line up with */
1133 			for (p = leader + lead_len - 1; p > leader
1134 						      && vim_iswhite(*p); --p)
1135 			    ;
1136 			++p;
1137 
1138 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
1139 			/* Compute the length of the replaced characters in
1140 			 * screen characters, not bytes. */
1141 			{
1142 			    int	    repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl,
1143 							       lead_repl_len);
1144 			    int	    old_size = 0;
1145 			    char_u  *endp = p;
1146 			    int	    l;
1147 
1148 			    while (old_size < repl_size && p > leader)
1149 			    {
1150 				mb_ptr_back(leader, p);
1151 				old_size += ptr2cells(p);
1152 			    }
1153 			    l = lead_repl_len - (int)(endp - p);
1154 			    if (l != 0)
1155 				mch_memmove(endp + l, endp,
1156 					(size_t)((leader + lead_len) - endp));
1157 			    lead_len += l;
1158 			}
1159 #else
1160 			if (p < leader + lead_repl_len)
1161 			    p = leader;
1162 			else
1163 			    p -= lead_repl_len;
1164 #endif
1165 			mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len);
1166 			if (p + lead_repl_len > leader + lead_len)
1167 			    p[lead_repl_len] = NUL;
1168 
1169 			/* blank-out any other chars from the old leader. */
1170 			while (--p >= leader)
1171 			{
1172 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
1173 			    int l = mb_head_off(leader, p);
1174 
1175 			    if (l > 1)
1176 			    {
1177 				p -= l;
1178 				if (ptr2cells(p) > 1)
1179 				{
1180 				    p[1] = ' ';
1181 				    --l;
1182 				}
1183 				mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l + 1,
1184 				   (size_t)((leader + lead_len) - (p + l + 1)));
1185 				lead_len -= l;
1186 				*p = ' ';
1187 			    }
1188 			    else
1189 #endif
1190 			    if (!vim_iswhite(*p))
1191 				*p = ' ';
1192 			}
1193 		    }
1194 		    else		    /* left adjusted leader */
1195 		    {
1196 			p = skipwhite(leader);
1197 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
1198 			/* Compute the length of the replaced characters in
1199 			 * screen characters, not bytes. Move the part that is
1200 			 * not to be overwritten. */
1201 			{
1202 			    int	    repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl,
1203 							       lead_repl_len);
1204 			    int	    i;
1205 			    int	    l;
1206 
1207 			    for (i = 0; p[i] != NUL && i < lead_len; i += l)
1208 			    {
1209 				l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i);
1210 				if (vim_strnsize(p, i + l) > repl_size)
1211 				    break;
1212 			    }
1213 			    if (i != lead_repl_len)
1214 			    {
1215 				mch_memmove(p + lead_repl_len, p + i,
1216 				       (size_t)(lead_len - i - (p - leader)));
1217 				lead_len += lead_repl_len - i;
1218 			    }
1219 			}
1220 #endif
1221 			mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len);
1222 
1223 			/* Replace any remaining non-white chars in the old
1224 			 * leader by spaces.  Keep Tabs, the indent must
1225 			 * remain the same. */
1226 			for (p += lead_repl_len; p < leader + lead_len; ++p)
1227 			    if (!vim_iswhite(*p))
1228 			    {
1229 				/* Don't put a space before a TAB. */
1230 				if (p + 1 < leader + lead_len && p[1] == TAB)
1231 				{
1232 				    --lead_len;
1233 				    mch_memmove(p, p + 1,
1234 						     (leader + lead_len) - p);
1235 				}
1236 				else
1237 				{
1238 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
1239 				    int	    l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p);
1240 
1241 				    if (l > 1)
1242 				    {
1243 					if (ptr2cells(p) > 1)
1244 					{
1245 					    /* Replace a double-wide char with
1246 					     * two spaces */
1247 					    --l;
1248 					    *p++ = ' ';
1249 					}
1250 					mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l,
1251 						     (leader + lead_len) - p);
1252 					lead_len -= l - 1;
1253 				    }
1254 #endif
1255 				    *p = ' ';
1256 				}
1257 			    }
1258 			*p = NUL;
1259 		    }
1260 
1261 		    /* Recompute the indent, it may have changed. */
1262 		    if (curbuf->b_p_ai
1263 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1264 					|| do_si
1265 #endif
1266 							   )
1267 			newindent = get_indent_str(leader, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE);
1268 
1269 		    /* Add the indent offset */
1270 		    if (newindent + off < 0)
1271 		    {
1272 			off = -newindent;
1273 			newindent = 0;
1274 		    }
1275 		    else
1276 			newindent += off;
1277 
1278 		    /* Correct trailing spaces for the shift, so that
1279 		     * alignment remains equal. */
1280 		    while (off > 0 && lead_len > 0
1281 					       && leader[lead_len - 1] == ' ')
1282 		    {
1283 			/* Don't do it when there is a tab before the space */
1284 			if (vim_strchr(skipwhite(leader), '\t') != NULL)
1285 			    break;
1286 			--lead_len;
1287 			--off;
1288 		    }
1289 
1290 		    /* If the leader ends in white space, don't add an
1291 		     * extra space */
1292 		    if (lead_len > 0 && vim_iswhite(leader[lead_len - 1]))
1293 			extra_space = FALSE;
1294 		    leader[lead_len] = NUL;
1295 		}
1296 
1297 		if (extra_space)
1298 		{
1299 		    leader[lead_len++] = ' ';
1300 		    leader[lead_len] = NUL;
1301 		}
1302 
1303 		newcol = lead_len;
1304 
1305 		/*
1306 		 * if a new indent will be set below, remove the indent that
1307 		 * is in the comment leader
1308 		 */
1309 		if (newindent
1310 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1311 				|| did_si
1312 #endif
1313 					   )
1314 		{
1315 		    while (lead_len && vim_iswhite(*leader))
1316 		    {
1317 			--lead_len;
1318 			--newcol;
1319 			++leader;
1320 		    }
1321 		}
1322 
1323 	    }
1324 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1325 	    did_si = can_si = FALSE;
1326 #endif
1327 	}
1328 	else if (comment_end != NULL)
1329 	{
1330 	    /*
1331 	     * We have finished a comment, so we don't use the leader.
1332 	     * If this was a C-comment and 'ai' or 'si' is set do a normal
1333 	     * indent to align with the line containing the start of the
1334 	     * comment.
1335 	     */
1336 	    if (comment_end[0] == '*' && comment_end[1] == '/' &&
1337 			(curbuf->b_p_ai
1338 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1339 					|| do_si
1340 #endif
1341 							   ))
1342 	    {
1343 		old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor;
1344 		curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(comment_end - saved_line);
1345 		if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL)
1346 		{
1347 		    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum;
1348 		    newindent = get_indent();
1349 		}
1350 		curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor;
1351 	    }
1352 	}
1353     }
1354 #endif
1355 
1356     /* (State == INSERT || State == REPLACE), only when dir == FORWARD */
1357     if (p_extra != NULL)
1358     {
1359 	*p_extra = saved_char;		/* restore char that NUL replaced */
1360 
1361 	/*
1362 	 * When 'ai' set or "flags" has OPENLINE_DELSPACES, skip to the first
1363 	 * non-blank.
1364 	 *
1365 	 * When in REPLACE mode, put the deleted blanks on the replace stack,
1366 	 * preceded by a NUL, so they can be put back when a BS is entered.
1367 	 */
1368 	if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State))
1369 	    replace_push(NUL);	    /* end of extra blanks */
1370 	if (curbuf->b_p_ai || (flags & OPENLINE_DELSPACES))
1371 	{
1372 	    while ((*p_extra == ' ' || *p_extra == '\t')
1373 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
1374 		    && (!enc_utf8
1375 			       || !utf_iscomposing(utf_ptr2char(p_extra + 1)))
1376 #endif
1377 		    )
1378 	    {
1379 		if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State))
1380 		    replace_push(*p_extra);
1381 		++p_extra;
1382 		++less_cols_off;
1383 	    }
1384 	}
1385 	if (*p_extra != NUL)
1386 	    did_ai = FALSE;	    /* append some text, don't truncate now */
1387 
1388 	/* columns for marks adjusted for removed columns */
1389 	less_cols = (int)(p_extra - saved_line);
1390     }
1391 
1392     if (p_extra == NULL)
1393 	p_extra = (char_u *)"";		    /* append empty line */
1394 
1395 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
1396     /* concatenate leader and p_extra, if there is a leader */
1397     if (lead_len)
1398     {
1399 	if (flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST && second_line_indent > 0)
1400 	{
1401 	    int i;
1402 	    int padding = second_line_indent
1403 					  - (newindent + (int)STRLEN(leader));
1404 
1405 	    /* Here whitespace is inserted after the comment char.
1406 	     * Below, set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT) will insert the
1407 	     * whitespace needed before the comment char. */
1408 	    for (i = 0; i < padding; i++)
1409 	    {
1410 		STRCAT(leader, " ");
1411 		less_cols--;
1412 		newcol++;
1413 	    }
1414 	}
1415 	STRCAT(leader, p_extra);
1416 	p_extra = leader;
1417 	did_ai = TRUE;	    /* So truncating blanks works with comments */
1418 	less_cols -= lead_len;
1419     }
1420     else
1421 	end_comment_pending = NUL;  /* turns out there was no leader */
1422 #endif
1423 
1424     old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor;
1425     if (dir == BACKWARD)
1426 	--curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
1427 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
1428     if (!(State & VREPLACE_FLAG) || old_cursor.lnum >= orig_line_count)
1429 #endif
1430     {
1431 	if (ml_append(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, (colnr_T)0, FALSE)
1432 								      == FAIL)
1433 	    goto theend;
1434 	/* Postpone calling changed_lines(), because it would mess up folding
1435 	 * with markers. */
1436 	mark_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, 1L, 0L);
1437 	did_append = TRUE;
1438     }
1439 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
1440     else
1441     {
1442 	/*
1443 	 * In VREPLACE mode we are starting to replace the next line.
1444 	 */
1445 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum++;
1446 	if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= Insstart.lnum + vr_lines_changed)
1447 	{
1448 	    /* In case we NL to a new line, BS to the previous one, and NL
1449 	     * again, we don't want to save the new line for undo twice.
1450 	     */
1451 	    (void)u_save_cursor();		    /* errors are ignored! */
1452 	    vr_lines_changed++;
1453 	}
1454 	ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, TRUE);
1455 	changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0);
1456 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum--;
1457 	did_append = FALSE;
1458     }
1459 #endif
1460 
1461     if (newindent
1462 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1463 		    || did_si
1464 #endif
1465 				)
1466     {
1467 	++curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
1468 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1469 	if (did_si)
1470 	{
1471 	    int sw = (int)get_sw_value(curbuf);
1472 
1473 	    if (p_sr)
1474 		newindent -= newindent % sw;
1475 	    newindent += sw;
1476 	}
1477 #endif
1478 	/* Copy the indent */
1479 	if (curbuf->b_p_ci)
1480 	{
1481 	    (void)copy_indent(newindent, saved_line);
1482 
1483 	    /*
1484 	     * Set the 'preserveindent' option so that any further screwing
1485 	     * with the line doesn't entirely destroy our efforts to preserve
1486 	     * it.  It gets restored at the function end.
1487 	     */
1488 	    curbuf->b_p_pi = TRUE;
1489 	}
1490 	else
1491 	    (void)set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT);
1492 	less_cols -= curwin->w_cursor.col;
1493 
1494 	ai_col = curwin->w_cursor.col;
1495 
1496 	/*
1497 	 * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the new indent, there must
1498 	 * be a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS
1499 	 */
1500 	if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State))
1501 	    for (n = 0; n < (int)curwin->w_cursor.col; ++n)
1502 		replace_push(NUL);
1503 	newcol += curwin->w_cursor.col;
1504 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT
1505 	if (no_si)
1506 	    did_si = FALSE;
1507 #endif
1508     }
1509 
1510 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
1511     /*
1512      * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the extra leader, there must be
1513      * a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS.
1514      */
1515     if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State))
1516 	while (lead_len-- > 0)
1517 	    replace_push(NUL);
1518 #endif
1519 
1520     curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor;
1521 
1522     if (dir == FORWARD)
1523     {
1524 	if (trunc_line || (State & INSERT))
1525 	{
1526 	    /* truncate current line at cursor */
1527 	    saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL;
1528 	    /* Remove trailing white space, unless OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL used. */
1529 	    if (trunc_line && !(flags & OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL))
1530 		truncate_spaces(saved_line);
1531 	    ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, saved_line, FALSE);
1532 	    saved_line = NULL;
1533 	    if (did_append)
1534 	    {
1535 		changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col,
1536 					       curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, 1L);
1537 		did_append = FALSE;
1538 
1539 		/* Move marks after the line break to the new line. */
1540 		if (flags & OPENLINE_MARKFIX)
1541 		    mark_col_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum,
1542 					 curwin->w_cursor.col + less_cols_off,
1543 							1L, (long)-less_cols);
1544 	    }
1545 	    else
1546 		changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col);
1547 	}
1548 
1549 	/*
1550 	 * Put the cursor on the new line.  Careful: the scrollup() above may
1551 	 * have moved w_cursor, we must use old_cursor.
1552 	 */
1553 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum = old_cursor.lnum + 1;
1554     }
1555     if (did_append)
1556 	changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 1L);
1557 
1558     curwin->w_cursor.col = newcol;
1559 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
1560     curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0;
1561 #endif
1562 
1563 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT))
1564     /*
1565      * In VREPLACE mode, we are handling the replace stack ourselves, so stop
1566      * fixthisline() from doing it (via change_indent()) by telling it we're in
1567      * normal INSERT mode.
1568      */
1569     if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG)
1570     {
1571 	vreplace_mode = State;	/* So we know to put things right later */
1572 	State = INSERT;
1573     }
1574     else
1575 	vreplace_mode = 0;
1576 #endif
1577 #ifdef FEAT_LISP
1578     /*
1579      * May do lisp indenting.
1580      */
1581     if (!p_paste
1582 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS
1583 	    && leader == NULL
1584 # endif
1585 	    && curbuf->b_p_lisp
1586 	    && curbuf->b_p_ai)
1587     {
1588 	fixthisline(get_lisp_indent);
1589 	p = ml_get_curline();
1590 	ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p);
1591     }
1592 #endif
1593 #ifdef FEAT_CINDENT
1594     /*
1595      * May do indenting after opening a new line.
1596      */
1597     if (!p_paste
1598 	    && (curbuf->b_p_cin
1599 #  ifdef FEAT_EVAL
1600 		    || *curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL
1601 #  endif
1602 		)
1603 	    && in_cinkeys(dir == FORWARD
1604 		? KEY_OPEN_FORW
1605 		: KEY_OPEN_BACK, ' ', linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum)))
1606     {
1607 	do_c_expr_indent();
1608 	p = ml_get_curline();
1609 	ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p);
1610     }
1611 #endif
1612 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT))
1613     if (vreplace_mode != 0)
1614 	State = vreplace_mode;
1615 #endif
1616 
1617 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
1618     /*
1619      * Finally, VREPLACE gets the stuff on the new line, then puts back the
1620      * original line, and inserts the new stuff char by char, pushing old stuff
1621      * onto the replace stack (via ins_char()).
1622      */
1623     if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG)
1624     {
1625 	/* Put new line in p_extra */
1626 	p_extra = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline());
1627 	if (p_extra == NULL)
1628 	    goto theend;
1629 
1630 	/* Put back original line */
1631 	ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, next_line, FALSE);
1632 
1633 	/* Insert new stuff into line again */
1634 	curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
1635 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
1636 	curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0;
1637 #endif
1638 	ins_bytes(p_extra);	/* will call changed_bytes() */
1639 	vim_free(p_extra);
1640 	next_line = NULL;
1641     }
1642 #endif
1643 
1644     retval = TRUE;		/* success! */
1645 theend:
1646     curbuf->b_p_pi = saved_pi;
1647     vim_free(saved_line);
1648     vim_free(next_line);
1649     vim_free(allocated);
1650     return retval;
1651 }
1652 
1653 #if defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(PROTO)
1654 /*
1655  * get_leader_len() returns the length in bytes of the prefix of the given
1656  * string which introduces a comment.  If this string is not a comment then
1657  * 0 is returned.
1658  * When "flags" is not NULL, it is set to point to the flags of the recognized
1659  * comment leader.
1660  * "backward" must be true for the "O" command.
1661  * If "include_space" is set, include trailing whitespace while calculating the
1662  * length.
1663  */
1664     int
1665 get_leader_len(line, flags, backward, include_space)
1666     char_u	*line;
1667     char_u	**flags;
1668     int		backward;
1669     int		include_space;
1670 {
1671     int		i, j;
1672     int		result;
1673     int		got_com = FALSE;
1674     int		found_one;
1675     char_u	part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN];	/* buffer for one option part */
1676     char_u	*string;		/* pointer to comment string */
1677     char_u	*list;
1678     int		middle_match_len = 0;
1679     char_u	*prev_list;
1680     char_u	*saved_flags = NULL;
1681 
1682     result = i = 0;
1683     while (vim_iswhite(line[i]))    /* leading white space is ignored */
1684 	++i;
1685 
1686     /*
1687      * Repeat to match several nested comment strings.
1688      */
1689     while (line[i] != NUL)
1690     {
1691 	/*
1692 	 * scan through the 'comments' option for a match
1693 	 */
1694 	found_one = FALSE;
1695 	for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; )
1696 	{
1697 	    /* Get one option part into part_buf[].  Advance "list" to next
1698 	     * one.  Put "string" at start of string.  */
1699 	    if (!got_com && flags != NULL)
1700 		*flags = list;	    /* remember where flags started */
1701 	    prev_list = list;
1702 	    (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
1703 	    string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':');
1704 	    if (string == NULL)	    /* missing ':', ignore this part */
1705 		continue;
1706 	    *string++ = NUL;	    /* isolate flags from string */
1707 
1708 	    /* If we found a middle match previously, use that match when this
1709 	     * is not a middle or end. */
1710 	    if (middle_match_len != 0
1711 		    && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) == NULL
1712 		    && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_END) == NULL)
1713 		break;
1714 
1715 	    /* When we already found a nested comment, only accept further
1716 	     * nested comments. */
1717 	    if (got_com && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL)
1718 		continue;
1719 
1720 	    /* When 'O' flag present and using "O" command skip this one. */
1721 	    if (backward && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NOBACK) != NULL)
1722 		continue;
1723 
1724 	    /* Line contents and string must match.
1725 	     * When string starts with white space, must have some white space
1726 	     * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of
1727 	     * TABs and spaces). */
1728 	    if (vim_iswhite(string[0]))
1729 	    {
1730 		if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1]))
1731 		    continue;  /* missing white space */
1732 		while (vim_iswhite(string[0]))
1733 		    ++string;
1734 	    }
1735 	    for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j)
1736 		;
1737 	    if (string[j] != NUL)
1738 		continue;  /* string doesn't match */
1739 
1740 	    /* When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an
1741 	     * end-of-line after the string in the line. */
1742 	    if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL
1743 			   && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL)
1744 		continue;
1745 
1746 	    /* We have found a match, stop searching unless this is a middle
1747 	     * comment. The middle comment can be a substring of the end
1748 	     * comment in which case it's better to return the length of the
1749 	     * end comment and its flags.  Thus we keep searching with middle
1750 	     * and end matches and use an end match if it matches better. */
1751 	    if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) != NULL)
1752 	    {
1753 		if (middle_match_len == 0)
1754 		{
1755 		    middle_match_len = j;
1756 		    saved_flags = prev_list;
1757 		}
1758 		continue;
1759 	    }
1760 	    if (middle_match_len != 0 && j > middle_match_len)
1761 		/* Use this match instead of the middle match, since it's a
1762 		 * longer thus better match. */
1763 		middle_match_len = 0;
1764 
1765 	    if (middle_match_len == 0)
1766 		i += j;
1767 	    found_one = TRUE;
1768 	    break;
1769 	}
1770 
1771 	if (middle_match_len != 0)
1772 	{
1773 	    /* Use the previously found middle match after failing to find a
1774 	     * match with an end. */
1775 	    if (!got_com && flags != NULL)
1776 		*flags = saved_flags;
1777 	    i += middle_match_len;
1778 	    found_one = TRUE;
1779 	}
1780 
1781 	/* No match found, stop scanning. */
1782 	if (!found_one)
1783 	    break;
1784 
1785 	result = i;
1786 
1787 	/* Include any trailing white space. */
1788 	while (vim_iswhite(line[i]))
1789 	    ++i;
1790 
1791 	if (include_space)
1792 	    result = i;
1793 
1794 	/* If this comment doesn't nest, stop here. */
1795 	got_com = TRUE;
1796 	if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL)
1797 	    break;
1798     }
1799     return result;
1800 }
1801 
1802 /*
1803  * Return the offset at which the last comment in line starts. If there is no
1804  * comment in the whole line, -1 is returned.
1805  *
1806  * When "flags" is not null, it is set to point to the flags describing the
1807  * recognized comment leader.
1808  */
1809     int
1810 get_last_leader_offset(line, flags)
1811     char_u	*line;
1812     char_u	**flags;
1813 {
1814     int		result = -1;
1815     int		i, j;
1816     int		lower_check_bound = 0;
1817     char_u	*string;
1818     char_u	*com_leader;
1819     char_u	*com_flags;
1820     char_u	*list;
1821     int		found_one;
1822     char_u	part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN];	/* buffer for one option part */
1823 
1824     /*
1825      * Repeat to match several nested comment strings.
1826      */
1827     i = (int)STRLEN(line);
1828     while (--i >= lower_check_bound)
1829     {
1830 	/*
1831 	 * scan through the 'comments' option for a match
1832 	 */
1833 	found_one = FALSE;
1834 	for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; )
1835 	{
1836 	    char_u *flags_save = list;
1837 
1838 	    /*
1839 	     * Get one option part into part_buf[].  Advance list to next one.
1840 	     * put string at start of string.
1841 	     */
1842 	    (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
1843 	    string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':');
1844 	    if (string == NULL)	/* If everything is fine, this cannot actually
1845 				 * happen. */
1846 	    {
1847 		continue;
1848 	    }
1849 	    *string++ = NUL;	/* Isolate flags from string. */
1850 	    com_leader = string;
1851 
1852 	    /*
1853 	     * Line contents and string must match.
1854 	     * When string starts with white space, must have some white space
1855 	     * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of
1856 	     * TABs and spaces).
1857 	     */
1858 	    if (vim_iswhite(string[0]))
1859 	    {
1860 		if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1]))
1861 		    continue;
1862 		while (vim_iswhite(string[0]))
1863 		    ++string;
1864 	    }
1865 	    for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j)
1866 		/* do nothing */;
1867 	    if (string[j] != NUL)
1868 		continue;
1869 
1870 	    /*
1871 	     * When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an
1872 	     * end-of-line after the string in the line.
1873 	     */
1874 	    if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL
1875 		    && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL)
1876 	    {
1877 		continue;
1878 	    }
1879 
1880 	    /*
1881 	     * We have found a match, stop searching.
1882 	     */
1883 	    found_one = TRUE;
1884 
1885 	    if (flags)
1886 		*flags = flags_save;
1887 	    com_flags = flags_save;
1888 
1889 	    break;
1890 	}
1891 
1892 	if (found_one)
1893 	{
1894 	    char_u  part_buf2[COM_MAX_LEN];	/* buffer for one option part */
1895 	    int     len1, len2, off;
1896 
1897 	    result = i;
1898 	    /*
1899 	     * If this comment nests, continue searching.
1900 	     */
1901 	    if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) != NULL)
1902 		continue;
1903 
1904 	    lower_check_bound = i;
1905 
1906 	    /* Let's verify whether the comment leader found is a substring
1907 	     * of other comment leaders. If it is, let's adjust the
1908 	     * lower_check_bound so that we make sure that we have determined
1909 	     * the comment leader correctly.
1910 	     */
1911 
1912 	    while (vim_iswhite(*com_leader))
1913 		++com_leader;
1914 	    len1 = (int)STRLEN(com_leader);
1915 
1916 	    for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; )
1917 	    {
1918 		char_u *flags_save = list;
1919 
1920 		(void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf2, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
1921 		if (flags_save == com_flags)
1922 		    continue;
1923 		string = vim_strchr(part_buf2, ':');
1924 		++string;
1925 		while (vim_iswhite(*string))
1926 		    ++string;
1927 		len2 = (int)STRLEN(string);
1928 		if (len2 == 0)
1929 		    continue;
1930 
1931 		/* Now we have to verify whether string ends with a substring
1932 		 * beginning the com_leader. */
1933 		for (off = (len2 > i ? i : len2); off > 0 && off + len1 > len2;)
1934 		{
1935 		    --off;
1936 		    if (!STRNCMP(string + off, com_leader, len2 - off))
1937 		    {
1938 			if (i - off < lower_check_bound)
1939 			    lower_check_bound = i - off;
1940 		    }
1941 		}
1942 	    }
1943 	}
1944     }
1945     return result;
1946 }
1947 #endif
1948 
1949 /*
1950  * Return the number of window lines occupied by buffer line "lnum".
1951  */
1952     int
1953 plines(lnum)
1954     linenr_T	lnum;
1955 {
1956     return plines_win(curwin, lnum, TRUE);
1957 }
1958 
1959     int
1960 plines_win(wp, lnum, winheight)
1961     win_T	*wp;
1962     linenr_T	lnum;
1963     int		winheight;	/* when TRUE limit to window height */
1964 {
1965 #if defined(FEAT_DIFF) || defined(PROTO)
1966     /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line.  When folded the result
1967      * is one line anyway. */
1968     return plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight) + diff_check_fill(wp, lnum);
1969 }
1970 
1971     int
1972 plines_nofill(lnum)
1973     linenr_T	lnum;
1974 {
1975     return plines_win_nofill(curwin, lnum, TRUE);
1976 }
1977 
1978     int
1979 plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight)
1980     win_T	*wp;
1981     linenr_T	lnum;
1982     int		winheight;	/* when TRUE limit to window height */
1983 {
1984 #endif
1985     int		lines;
1986 
1987     if (!wp->w_p_wrap)
1988 	return 1;
1989 
1990 #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT
1991     if (wp->w_width == 0)
1992 	return 1;
1993 #endif
1994 
1995 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
1996     /* A folded lines is handled just like an empty line. */
1997     /* NOTE: Caller must handle lines that are MAYBE folded. */
1998     if (lineFolded(wp, lnum) == TRUE)
1999 	return 1;
2000 #endif
2001 
2002     lines = plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum);
2003     if (winheight > 0 && lines > wp->w_height)
2004 	return (int)wp->w_height;
2005     return lines;
2006 }
2007 
2008 /*
2009  * Return number of window lines physical line "lnum" will occupy in window
2010  * "wp".  Does not care about folding, 'wrap' or 'diff'.
2011  */
2012     int
2013 plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum)
2014     win_T	*wp;
2015     linenr_T	lnum;
2016 {
2017     char_u	*s;
2018     long	col;
2019     int		width;
2020 
2021     s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE);
2022     if (*s == NUL)		/* empty line */
2023 	return 1;
2024     col = win_linetabsize(wp, s, (colnr_T)MAXCOL);
2025 
2026     /*
2027      * If list mode is on, then the '$' at the end of the line may take up one
2028      * extra column.
2029      */
2030     if (wp->w_p_list && lcs_eol != NUL)
2031 	col += 1;
2032 
2033     /*
2034      * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber' and 'foldcolumn'.
2035      */
2036     width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp);
2037     if (width <= 0)
2038 	return 32000;
2039     if (col <= width)
2040 	return 1;
2041     col -= width;
2042     width += win_col_off2(wp);
2043     return (col + (width - 1)) / width + 1;
2044 }
2045 
2046 /*
2047  * Like plines_win(), but only reports the number of physical screen lines
2048  * used from the start of the line to the given column number.
2049  */
2050     int
2051 plines_win_col(wp, lnum, column)
2052     win_T	*wp;
2053     linenr_T	lnum;
2054     long	column;
2055 {
2056     long	col;
2057     char_u	*s;
2058     int		lines = 0;
2059     int		width;
2060     char_u	*line;
2061 
2062 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
2063     /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line.  When folded the result
2064      * is one line anyway. */
2065     lines = diff_check_fill(wp, lnum);
2066 #endif
2067 
2068     if (!wp->w_p_wrap)
2069 	return lines + 1;
2070 
2071 #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT
2072     if (wp->w_width == 0)
2073 	return lines + 1;
2074 #endif
2075 
2076     line = s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE);
2077 
2078     col = 0;
2079     while (*s != NUL && --column >= 0)
2080     {
2081 	col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, line, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL);
2082 	mb_ptr_adv(s);
2083     }
2084 
2085     /*
2086      * If *s is a TAB, and the TAB is not displayed as ^I, and we're not in
2087      * INSERT mode, then col must be adjusted so that it represents the last
2088      * screen position of the TAB.  This only fixes an error when the TAB wraps
2089      * from one screen line to the next (when 'columns' is not a multiple of
2090      * 'ts') -- webb.
2091      */
2092     if (*s == TAB && (State & NORMAL) && (!wp->w_p_list || lcs_tab1))
2093 	col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, line, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL) - 1;
2094 
2095     /*
2096      * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber', 'foldcolumn', etc.
2097      */
2098     width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp);
2099     if (width <= 0)
2100 	return 9999;
2101 
2102     lines += 1;
2103     if (col > width)
2104 	lines += (col - width) / (width + win_col_off2(wp)) + 1;
2105     return lines;
2106 }
2107 
2108     int
2109 plines_m_win(wp, first, last)
2110     win_T	*wp;
2111     linenr_T	first, last;
2112 {
2113     int		count = 0;
2114 
2115     while (first <= last)
2116     {
2117 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
2118 	int	x;
2119 
2120 	/* Check if there are any really folded lines, but also included lines
2121 	 * that are maybe folded. */
2122 	x = foldedCount(wp, first, NULL);
2123 	if (x > 0)
2124 	{
2125 	    ++count;	    /* count 1 for "+-- folded" line */
2126 	    first += x;
2127 	}
2128 	else
2129 #endif
2130 	{
2131 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
2132 	    if (first == wp->w_topline)
2133 		count += plines_win_nofill(wp, first, TRUE) + wp->w_topfill;
2134 	    else
2135 #endif
2136 		count += plines_win(wp, first, TRUE);
2137 	    ++first;
2138 	}
2139     }
2140     return (count);
2141 }
2142 
2143 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) || defined(PROTO)
2144 /*
2145  * Insert string "p" at the cursor position.  Stops at a NUL byte.
2146  * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters.
2147  */
2148     void
2149 ins_bytes(p)
2150     char_u	*p;
2151 {
2152     ins_bytes_len(p, (int)STRLEN(p));
2153 }
2154 #endif
2155 
2156 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) \
2157 	|| defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO)
2158 /*
2159  * Insert string "p" with length "len" at the cursor position.
2160  * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters.
2161  */
2162     void
2163 ins_bytes_len(p, len)
2164     char_u	*p;
2165     int		len;
2166 {
2167     int		i;
2168 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2169     int		n;
2170 
2171     if (has_mbyte)
2172 	for (i = 0; i < len; i += n)
2173 	{
2174 	    if (enc_utf8)
2175 		/* avoid reading past p[len] */
2176 		n = utfc_ptr2len_len(p + i, len - i);
2177 	    else
2178 		n = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i);
2179 	    ins_char_bytes(p + i, n);
2180 	}
2181     else
2182 # endif
2183 	for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2184 	    ins_char(p[i]);
2185 }
2186 #endif
2187 
2188 /*
2189  * Insert or replace a single character at the cursor position.
2190  * When in REPLACE or VREPLACE mode, replace any existing character.
2191  * Caller must have prepared for undo.
2192  * For multi-byte characters we get the whole character, the caller must
2193  * convert bytes to a character.
2194  */
2195     void
2196 ins_char(c)
2197     int		c;
2198 {
2199 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO)
2200     char_u	buf[MB_MAXBYTES + 1];
2201     int		n;
2202 
2203     n = (*mb_char2bytes)(c, buf);
2204 
2205     /* When "c" is 0x100, 0x200, etc. we don't want to insert a NUL byte.
2206      * Happens for CTRL-Vu9900. */
2207     if (buf[0] == 0)
2208 	buf[0] = '\n';
2209 
2210     ins_char_bytes(buf, n);
2211 }
2212 
2213     void
2214 ins_char_bytes(buf, charlen)
2215     char_u	*buf;
2216     int		charlen;
2217 {
2218     int		c = buf[0];
2219 #endif
2220     int		newlen;		/* nr of bytes inserted */
2221     int		oldlen;		/* nr of bytes deleted (0 when not replacing) */
2222     char_u	*p;
2223     char_u	*newp;
2224     char_u	*oldp;
2225     int		linelen;	/* length of old line including NUL */
2226     colnr_T	col;
2227     linenr_T	lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
2228     int		i;
2229 
2230 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
2231     /* Break tabs if needed. */
2232     if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0)
2233 	coladvance_force(getviscol());
2234 #endif
2235 
2236     col = curwin->w_cursor.col;
2237     oldp = ml_get(lnum);
2238     linelen = (int)STRLEN(oldp) + 1;
2239 
2240     /* The lengths default to the values for when not replacing. */
2241     oldlen = 0;
2242 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2243     newlen = charlen;
2244 #else
2245     newlen = 1;
2246 #endif
2247 
2248     if (State & REPLACE_FLAG)
2249     {
2250 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE
2251 	if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG)
2252 	{
2253 	    colnr_T	new_vcol = 0;   /* init for GCC */
2254 	    colnr_T	vcol;
2255 	    int		old_list;
2256 #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE
2257 	    char_u	buf[2];
2258 #endif
2259 
2260 	    /*
2261 	     * Disable 'list' temporarily, unless 'cpo' contains the 'L' flag.
2262 	     * Returns the old value of list, so when finished,
2263 	     * curwin->w_p_list should be set back to this.
2264 	     */
2265 	    old_list = curwin->w_p_list;
2266 	    if (old_list && vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISTWM) == NULL)
2267 		curwin->w_p_list = FALSE;
2268 
2269 	    /*
2270 	     * In virtual replace mode each character may replace one or more
2271 	     * characters (zero if it's a TAB).  Count the number of bytes to
2272 	     * be deleted to make room for the new character, counting screen
2273 	     * cells.  May result in adding spaces to fill a gap.
2274 	     */
2275 	    getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, NULL, &vcol, NULL);
2276 #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE
2277 	    buf[0] = c;
2278 	    buf[1] = NUL;
2279 #endif
2280 	    new_vcol = vcol + chartabsize(buf, vcol);
2281 	    while (oldp[col + oldlen] != NUL && vcol < new_vcol)
2282 	    {
2283 		vcol += chartabsize(oldp + col + oldlen, vcol);
2284 		/* Don't need to remove a TAB that takes us to the right
2285 		 * position. */
2286 		if (vcol > new_vcol && oldp[col + oldlen] == TAB)
2287 		    break;
2288 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2289 		oldlen += (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col + oldlen);
2290 #else
2291 		++oldlen;
2292 #endif
2293 		/* Deleted a bit too much, insert spaces. */
2294 		if (vcol > new_vcol)
2295 		    newlen += vcol - new_vcol;
2296 	    }
2297 	    curwin->w_p_list = old_list;
2298 	}
2299 	else
2300 #endif
2301 	    if (oldp[col] != NUL)
2302 	{
2303 	    /* normal replace */
2304 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2305 	    oldlen = (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col);
2306 #else
2307 	    oldlen = 1;
2308 #endif
2309 	}
2310 
2311 
2312 	/* Push the replaced bytes onto the replace stack, so that they can be
2313 	 * put back when BS is used.  The bytes of a multi-byte character are
2314 	 * done the other way around, so that the first byte is popped off
2315 	 * first (it tells the byte length of the character). */
2316 	replace_push(NUL);
2317 	for (i = 0; i < oldlen; ++i)
2318 	{
2319 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2320 	    if (has_mbyte)
2321 		i += replace_push_mb(oldp + col + i) - 1;
2322 	    else
2323 #endif
2324 		replace_push(oldp[col + i]);
2325 	}
2326     }
2327 
2328     newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(linelen + newlen - oldlen));
2329     if (newp == NULL)
2330 	return;
2331 
2332     /* Copy bytes before the cursor. */
2333     if (col > 0)
2334 	mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col);
2335 
2336     /* Copy bytes after the changed character(s). */
2337     p = newp + col;
2338     mch_memmove(p + newlen, oldp + col + oldlen,
2339 					    (size_t)(linelen - col - oldlen));
2340 
2341     /* Insert or overwrite the new character. */
2342 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2343     mch_memmove(p, buf, charlen);
2344     i = charlen;
2345 #else
2346     *p = c;
2347     i = 1;
2348 #endif
2349 
2350     /* Fill with spaces when necessary. */
2351     while (i < newlen)
2352 	p[i++] = ' ';
2353 
2354     /* Replace the line in the buffer. */
2355     ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE);
2356 
2357     /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */
2358     changed_bytes(lnum, col);
2359 
2360     /*
2361      * If we're in Insert or Replace mode and 'showmatch' is set, then briefly
2362      * show the match for right parens and braces.
2363      */
2364     if (p_sm && (State & INSERT)
2365 	    && msg_silent == 0
2366 #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND
2367 	    && !ins_compl_active()
2368 #endif
2369        )
2370     {
2371 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2372 	if (has_mbyte)
2373 	    showmatch(mb_ptr2char(buf));
2374 	else
2375 #endif
2376 	    showmatch(c);
2377     }
2378 
2379 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
2380     if (!p_ri || (State & REPLACE_FLAG))
2381 #endif
2382     {
2383 	/* Normal insert: move cursor right */
2384 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2385 	curwin->w_cursor.col += charlen;
2386 #else
2387 	++curwin->w_cursor.col;
2388 #endif
2389     }
2390     /*
2391      * TODO: should try to update w_row here, to avoid recomputing it later.
2392      */
2393 }
2394 
2395 /*
2396  * Insert a string at the cursor position.
2397  * Note: Does NOT handle Replace mode.
2398  * Caller must have prepared for undo.
2399  */
2400     void
2401 ins_str(s)
2402     char_u	*s;
2403 {
2404     char_u	*oldp, *newp;
2405     int		newlen = (int)STRLEN(s);
2406     int		oldlen;
2407     colnr_T	col;
2408     linenr_T	lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
2409 
2410 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
2411     if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0)
2412 	coladvance_force(getviscol());
2413 #endif
2414 
2415     col = curwin->w_cursor.col;
2416     oldp = ml_get(lnum);
2417     oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp);
2418 
2419     newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(oldlen + newlen + 1));
2420     if (newp == NULL)
2421 	return;
2422     if (col > 0)
2423 	mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col);
2424     mch_memmove(newp + col, s, (size_t)newlen);
2425     mch_memmove(newp + col + newlen, oldp + col, (size_t)(oldlen - col + 1));
2426     ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE);
2427     changed_bytes(lnum, col);
2428     curwin->w_cursor.col += newlen;
2429 }
2430 
2431 /*
2432  * Delete one character under the cursor.
2433  * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line.
2434  * Caller must have prepared for undo.
2435  *
2436  * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise
2437  */
2438     int
2439 del_char(fixpos)
2440     int		fixpos;
2441 {
2442 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2443     if (has_mbyte)
2444     {
2445 	/* Make sure the cursor is at the start of a character. */
2446 	mb_adjust_cursor();
2447 	if (*ml_get_cursor() == NUL)
2448 	    return FAIL;
2449 	return del_chars(1L, fixpos);
2450     }
2451 #endif
2452     return del_bytes(1L, fixpos, TRUE);
2453 }
2454 
2455 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO)
2456 /*
2457  * Like del_bytes(), but delete characters instead of bytes.
2458  */
2459     int
2460 del_chars(count, fixpos)
2461     long	count;
2462     int		fixpos;
2463 {
2464     long	bytes = 0;
2465     long	i;
2466     char_u	*p;
2467     int		l;
2468 
2469     p = ml_get_cursor();
2470     for (i = 0; i < count && *p != NUL; ++i)
2471     {
2472 	l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p);
2473 	bytes += l;
2474 	p += l;
2475     }
2476     return del_bytes(bytes, fixpos, TRUE);
2477 }
2478 #endif
2479 
2480 /*
2481  * Delete "count" bytes under the cursor.
2482  * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line.
2483  * Caller must have prepared for undo.
2484  *
2485  * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise
2486  */
2487     int
2488 del_bytes(count, fixpos_arg, use_delcombine)
2489     long	count;
2490     int		fixpos_arg;
2491     int		use_delcombine UNUSED;	    /* 'delcombine' option applies */
2492 {
2493     char_u	*oldp, *newp;
2494     colnr_T	oldlen;
2495     linenr_T	lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
2496     colnr_T	col = curwin->w_cursor.col;
2497     int		was_alloced;
2498     long	movelen;
2499     int		fixpos = fixpos_arg;
2500 
2501     oldp = ml_get(lnum);
2502     oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp);
2503 
2504     /*
2505      * Can't do anything when the cursor is on the NUL after the line.
2506      */
2507     if (col >= oldlen)
2508 	return FAIL;
2509 
2510 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2511     /* If 'delcombine' is set and deleting (less than) one character, only
2512      * delete the last combining character. */
2513     if (p_deco && use_delcombine && enc_utf8
2514 					 && utfc_ptr2len(oldp + col) >= count)
2515     {
2516 	int	cc[MAX_MCO];
2517 	int	n;
2518 
2519 	(void)utfc_ptr2char(oldp + col, cc);
2520 	if (cc[0] != NUL)
2521 	{
2522 	    /* Find the last composing char, there can be several. */
2523 	    n = col;
2524 	    do
2525 	    {
2526 		col = n;
2527 		count = utf_ptr2len(oldp + n);
2528 		n += count;
2529 	    } while (UTF_COMPOSINGLIKE(oldp + col, oldp + n));
2530 	    fixpos = 0;
2531 	}
2532     }
2533 #endif
2534 
2535     /*
2536      * When count is too big, reduce it.
2537      */
2538     movelen = (long)oldlen - (long)col - count + 1; /* includes trailing NUL */
2539     if (movelen <= 1)
2540     {
2541 	/*
2542 	 * If we just took off the last character of a non-blank line, and
2543 	 * fixpos is TRUE, we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL,
2544 	 * unless "restart_edit" is set or 'virtualedit' contains "onemore".
2545 	 */
2546 	if (col > 0 && fixpos && restart_edit == 0
2547 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
2548 					      && (ve_flags & VE_ONEMORE) == 0
2549 #endif
2550 					      )
2551 	{
2552 	    --curwin->w_cursor.col;
2553 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
2554 	    curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0;
2555 #endif
2556 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2557 	    if (has_mbyte)
2558 		curwin->w_cursor.col -=
2559 			    (*mb_head_off)(oldp, oldp + curwin->w_cursor.col);
2560 #endif
2561 	}
2562 	count = oldlen - col;
2563 	movelen = 1;
2564     }
2565 
2566     /*
2567      * If the old line has been allocated the deletion can be done in the
2568      * existing line. Otherwise a new line has to be allocated
2569      * Can't do this when using Netbeans, because we would need to invoke
2570      * netbeans_removed(), which deallocates the line.  Let ml_replace() take
2571      * care of notifying Netbeans.
2572      */
2573 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG
2574     if (netbeans_active())
2575 	was_alloced = FALSE;
2576     else
2577 #endif
2578 	was_alloced = ml_line_alloced();    /* check if oldp was allocated */
2579     if (was_alloced)
2580 	newp = oldp;			    /* use same allocated memory */
2581     else
2582     {					    /* need to allocate a new line */
2583 	newp = alloc((unsigned)(oldlen + 1 - count));
2584 	if (newp == NULL)
2585 	    return FAIL;
2586 	mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col);
2587     }
2588     mch_memmove(newp + col, oldp + col + count, (size_t)movelen);
2589     if (!was_alloced)
2590 	ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE);
2591 
2592     /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */
2593     changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col);
2594 
2595     return OK;
2596 }
2597 
2598 /*
2599  * Delete from cursor to end of line.
2600  * Caller must have prepared for undo.
2601  *
2602  * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise
2603  */
2604     int
2605 truncate_line(fixpos)
2606     int		fixpos;	    /* if TRUE fix the cursor position when done */
2607 {
2608     char_u	*newp;
2609     linenr_T	lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
2610     colnr_T	col = curwin->w_cursor.col;
2611 
2612     if (col == 0)
2613 	newp = vim_strsave((char_u *)"");
2614     else
2615 	newp = vim_strnsave(ml_get(lnum), col);
2616 
2617     if (newp == NULL)
2618 	return FAIL;
2619 
2620     ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE);
2621 
2622     /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */
2623     changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col);
2624 
2625     /*
2626      * If "fixpos" is TRUE we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL.
2627      */
2628     if (fixpos && curwin->w_cursor.col > 0)
2629 	--curwin->w_cursor.col;
2630 
2631     return OK;
2632 }
2633 
2634 /*
2635  * Delete "nlines" lines at the cursor.
2636  * Saves the lines for undo first if "undo" is TRUE.
2637  */
2638     void
2639 del_lines(nlines, undo)
2640     long	nlines;		/* number of lines to delete */
2641     int		undo;		/* if TRUE, prepare for undo */
2642 {
2643     long	n;
2644     linenr_T	first = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
2645 
2646     if (nlines <= 0)
2647 	return;
2648 
2649     /* save the deleted lines for undo */
2650     if (undo && u_savedel(first, nlines) == FAIL)
2651 	return;
2652 
2653     for (n = 0; n < nlines; )
2654     {
2655 	if (curbuf->b_ml.ml_flags & ML_EMPTY)	    /* nothing to delete */
2656 	    break;
2657 
2658 	ml_delete(first, TRUE);
2659 	++n;
2660 
2661 	/* If we delete the last line in the file, stop */
2662 	if (first > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
2663 	    break;
2664     }
2665 
2666     /* Correct the cursor position before calling deleted_lines_mark(), it may
2667      * trigger a callback to display the cursor. */
2668     curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
2669     check_cursor_lnum();
2670 
2671     /* adjust marks, mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */
2672     deleted_lines_mark(first, n);
2673 }
2674 
2675     int
2676 gchar_pos(pos)
2677     pos_T *pos;
2678 {
2679     char_u	*ptr = ml_get_pos(pos);
2680 
2681 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2682     if (has_mbyte)
2683 	return (*mb_ptr2char)(ptr);
2684 #endif
2685     return (int)*ptr;
2686 }
2687 
2688     int
2689 gchar_cursor()
2690 {
2691 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
2692     if (has_mbyte)
2693 	return (*mb_ptr2char)(ml_get_cursor());
2694 #endif
2695     return (int)*ml_get_cursor();
2696 }
2697 
2698 /*
2699  * Write a character at the current cursor position.
2700  * It is directly written into the block.
2701  */
2702     void
2703 pchar_cursor(c)
2704     int c;
2705 {
2706     *(ml_get_buf(curbuf, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, TRUE)
2707 						  + curwin->w_cursor.col) = c;
2708 }
2709 
2710 /*
2711  * When extra == 0: Return TRUE if the cursor is before or on the first
2712  *		    non-blank in the line.
2713  * When extra == 1: Return TRUE if the cursor is before the first non-blank in
2714  *		    the line.
2715  */
2716     int
2717 inindent(extra)
2718     int	    extra;
2719 {
2720     char_u	*ptr;
2721     colnr_T	col;
2722 
2723     for (col = 0, ptr = ml_get_curline(); vim_iswhite(*ptr); ++col)
2724 	++ptr;
2725     if (col >= curwin->w_cursor.col + extra)
2726 	return TRUE;
2727     else
2728 	return FALSE;
2729 }
2730 
2731 /*
2732  * Skip to next part of an option argument: Skip space and comma.
2733  */
2734     char_u *
2735 skip_to_option_part(p)
2736     char_u  *p;
2737 {
2738     if (*p == ',')
2739 	++p;
2740     while (*p == ' ')
2741 	++p;
2742     return p;
2743 }
2744 
2745 /*
2746  * Call this function when something in the current buffer is changed.
2747  *
2748  * Most often called through changed_bytes() and changed_lines(), which also
2749  * mark the area of the display to be redrawn.
2750  *
2751  * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer.
2752  */
2753     void
2754 changed()
2755 {
2756 #if defined(FEAT_XIM) && defined(FEAT_GUI_GTK)
2757     /* The text of the preediting area is inserted, but this doesn't
2758      * mean a change of the buffer yet.  That is delayed until the
2759      * text is committed. (this means preedit becomes empty) */
2760     if (im_is_preediting() && !xim_changed_while_preediting)
2761 	return;
2762     xim_changed_while_preediting = FALSE;
2763 #endif
2764 
2765     if (!curbuf->b_changed)
2766     {
2767 	int	save_msg_scroll = msg_scroll;
2768 
2769 	/* Give a warning about changing a read-only file.  This may also
2770 	 * check-out the file, thus change "curbuf"! */
2771 	change_warning(0);
2772 
2773 	/* Create a swap file if that is wanted.
2774 	 * Don't do this for "nofile" and "nowrite" buffer types. */
2775 	if (curbuf->b_may_swap
2776 #ifdef FEAT_QUICKFIX
2777 		&& !bt_dontwrite(curbuf)
2778 #endif
2779 		)
2780 	{
2781 	    ml_open_file(curbuf);
2782 
2783 	    /* The ml_open_file() can cause an ATTENTION message.
2784 	     * Wait two seconds, to make sure the user reads this unexpected
2785 	     * message.  Since we could be anywhere, call wait_return() now,
2786 	     * and don't let the emsg() set msg_scroll. */
2787 	    if (need_wait_return && emsg_silent == 0)
2788 	    {
2789 		out_flush();
2790 		ui_delay(2000L, TRUE);
2791 		wait_return(TRUE);
2792 		msg_scroll = save_msg_scroll;
2793 	    }
2794 	}
2795 	changed_int();
2796     }
2797     ++curbuf->b_changedtick;
2798 }
2799 
2800 /*
2801  * Internal part of changed(), no user interaction.
2802  */
2803     void
2804 changed_int()
2805 {
2806     curbuf->b_changed = TRUE;
2807     ml_setflags(curbuf);
2808 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
2809     check_status(curbuf);
2810     redraw_tabline = TRUE;
2811 #endif
2812 #ifdef FEAT_TITLE
2813     need_maketitle = TRUE;	    /* set window title later */
2814 #endif
2815 }
2816 
2817 static void changedOneline __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum));
2818 static void changed_lines_buf __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum, linenr_T lnume, long xtra));
2819 static void changed_common __ARGS((linenr_T lnum, colnr_T col, linenr_T lnume, long xtra));
2820 
2821 /*
2822  * Changed bytes within a single line for the current buffer.
2823  * - marks the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed
2824  * - marks the buffer changed by calling changed()
2825  * - invalidates cached values
2826  * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer.
2827  */
2828     void
2829 changed_bytes(lnum, col)
2830     linenr_T	lnum;
2831     colnr_T	col;
2832 {
2833     changedOneline(curbuf, lnum);
2834     changed_common(lnum, col, lnum + 1, 0L);
2835 
2836 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
2837     /* Diff highlighting in other diff windows may need to be updated too. */
2838     if (curwin->w_p_diff)
2839     {
2840 	win_T	    *wp;
2841 	linenr_T    wlnum;
2842 
2843 	for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next)
2844 	    if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin)
2845 	    {
2846 		redraw_win_later(wp, VALID);
2847 		wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp);
2848 		if (wlnum > 0)
2849 		    changedOneline(wp->w_buffer, wlnum);
2850 	    }
2851     }
2852 #endif
2853 }
2854 
2855     static void
2856 changedOneline(buf, lnum)
2857     buf_T	*buf;
2858     linenr_T	lnum;
2859 {
2860     if (buf->b_mod_set)
2861     {
2862 	/* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */
2863 	if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top)
2864 	    buf->b_mod_top = lnum;
2865 	else if (lnum >= buf->b_mod_bot)
2866 	    buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1;
2867     }
2868     else
2869     {
2870 	/* set the area that must be redisplayed to one line */
2871 	buf->b_mod_set = TRUE;
2872 	buf->b_mod_top = lnum;
2873 	buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1;
2874 	buf->b_mod_xlines = 0;
2875     }
2876 }
2877 
2878 /*
2879  * Appended "count" lines below line "lnum" in the current buffer.
2880  * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust().
2881  * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag.
2882  */
2883     void
2884 appended_lines(lnum, count)
2885     linenr_T	lnum;
2886     long	count;
2887 {
2888     changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count);
2889 }
2890 
2891 /*
2892  * Like appended_lines(), but adjust marks first.
2893  */
2894     void
2895 appended_lines_mark(lnum, count)
2896     linenr_T	lnum;
2897     long	count;
2898 {
2899     mark_adjust(lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, count, 0L);
2900     changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count);
2901 }
2902 
2903 /*
2904  * Deleted "count" lines at line "lnum" in the current buffer.
2905  * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust().
2906  * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag.
2907  */
2908     void
2909 deleted_lines(lnum, count)
2910     linenr_T	lnum;
2911     long	count;
2912 {
2913     changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count);
2914 }
2915 
2916 /*
2917  * Like deleted_lines(), but adjust marks first.
2918  * Make sure the cursor is on a valid line before calling, a GUI callback may
2919  * be triggered to display the cursor.
2920  */
2921     void
2922 deleted_lines_mark(lnum, count)
2923     linenr_T	lnum;
2924     long	count;
2925 {
2926     mark_adjust(lnum, (linenr_T)(lnum + count - 1), (long)MAXLNUM, -count);
2927     changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count);
2928 }
2929 
2930 /*
2931  * Changed lines for the current buffer.
2932  * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust().
2933  * - mark the buffer changed by calling changed()
2934  * - mark the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed
2935  * - invalidate cached values
2936  * "lnum" is the first line that needs displaying, "lnume" the first line
2937  * below the changed lines (BEFORE the change).
2938  * When only inserting lines, "lnum" and "lnume" are equal.
2939  * Takes care of calling changed() and updating b_mod_*.
2940  * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer.
2941  */
2942     void
2943 changed_lines(lnum, col, lnume, xtra)
2944     linenr_T	lnum;	    /* first line with change */
2945     colnr_T	col;	    /* column in first line with change */
2946     linenr_T	lnume;	    /* line below last changed line */
2947     long	xtra;	    /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */
2948 {
2949     changed_lines_buf(curbuf, lnum, lnume, xtra);
2950 
2951 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
2952     if (xtra == 0 && curwin->w_p_diff)
2953     {
2954 	/* When the number of lines doesn't change then mark_adjust() isn't
2955 	 * called and other diff buffers still need to be marked for
2956 	 * displaying. */
2957 	win_T	    *wp;
2958 	linenr_T    wlnum;
2959 
2960 	for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next)
2961 	    if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin)
2962 	    {
2963 		redraw_win_later(wp, VALID);
2964 		wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp);
2965 		if (wlnum > 0)
2966 		    changed_lines_buf(wp->w_buffer, wlnum,
2967 						    lnume - lnum + wlnum, 0L);
2968 	    }
2969     }
2970 #endif
2971 
2972     changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra);
2973 }
2974 
2975     static void
2976 changed_lines_buf(buf, lnum, lnume, xtra)
2977     buf_T	*buf;
2978     linenr_T	lnum;	    /* first line with change */
2979     linenr_T	lnume;	    /* line below last changed line */
2980     long	xtra;	    /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */
2981 {
2982     if (buf->b_mod_set)
2983     {
2984 	/* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */
2985 	if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top)
2986 	    buf->b_mod_top = lnum;
2987 	if (lnum < buf->b_mod_bot)
2988 	{
2989 	    /* adjust old bot position for xtra lines */
2990 	    buf->b_mod_bot += xtra;
2991 	    if (buf->b_mod_bot < lnum)
2992 		buf->b_mod_bot = lnum;
2993 	}
2994 	if (lnume + xtra > buf->b_mod_bot)
2995 	    buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra;
2996 	buf->b_mod_xlines += xtra;
2997     }
2998     else
2999     {
3000 	/* set the area that must be redisplayed */
3001 	buf->b_mod_set = TRUE;
3002 	buf->b_mod_top = lnum;
3003 	buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra;
3004 	buf->b_mod_xlines = xtra;
3005     }
3006 }
3007 
3008 /*
3009  * Common code for when a change is was made.
3010  * See changed_lines() for the arguments.
3011  * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer.
3012  */
3013     static void
3014 changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra)
3015     linenr_T	lnum;
3016     colnr_T	col;
3017     linenr_T	lnume;
3018     long	xtra;
3019 {
3020     win_T	*wp;
3021 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
3022     tabpage_T	*tp;
3023 #endif
3024     int		i;
3025 #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST
3026     int		cols;
3027     pos_T	*p;
3028     int		add;
3029 #endif
3030 
3031     /* mark the buffer as modified */
3032     changed();
3033 
3034     /* set the '. mark */
3035     if (!cmdmod.keepjumps)
3036     {
3037 	curbuf->b_last_change.lnum = lnum;
3038 	curbuf->b_last_change.col = col;
3039 
3040 #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST
3041 	/* Create a new entry if a new undo-able change was started or we
3042 	 * don't have an entry yet. */
3043 	if (curbuf->b_new_change || curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0)
3044 	{
3045 	    if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0)
3046 		add = TRUE;
3047 	    else
3048 	    {
3049 		/* Don't create a new entry when the line number is the same
3050 		 * as the last one and the column is not too far away.  Avoids
3051 		 * creating many entries for typing "xxxxx". */
3052 		p = &curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1];
3053 		if (p->lnum != lnum)
3054 		    add = TRUE;
3055 		else
3056 		{
3057 		    cols = comp_textwidth(FALSE);
3058 		    if (cols == 0)
3059 			cols = 79;
3060 		    add = (p->col + cols < col || col + cols < p->col);
3061 		}
3062 	    }
3063 	    if (add)
3064 	    {
3065 		/* This is the first of a new sequence of undo-able changes
3066 		 * and it's at some distance of the last change.  Use a new
3067 		 * position in the changelist. */
3068 		curbuf->b_new_change = FALSE;
3069 
3070 		if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == JUMPLISTSIZE)
3071 		{
3072 		    /* changelist is full: remove oldest entry */
3073 		    curbuf->b_changelistlen = JUMPLISTSIZE - 1;
3074 		    mch_memmove(curbuf->b_changelist, curbuf->b_changelist + 1,
3075 					  sizeof(pos_T) * (JUMPLISTSIZE - 1));
3076 		    FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp)
3077 		    {
3078 			/* Correct position in changelist for other windows on
3079 			 * this buffer. */
3080 			if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf && wp->w_changelistidx > 0)
3081 			    --wp->w_changelistidx;
3082 		    }
3083 		}
3084 		FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp)
3085 		{
3086 		    /* For other windows, if the position in the changelist is
3087 		     * at the end it stays at the end. */
3088 		    if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf
3089 			    && wp->w_changelistidx == curbuf->b_changelistlen)
3090 			++wp->w_changelistidx;
3091 		}
3092 		++curbuf->b_changelistlen;
3093 	    }
3094 	}
3095 	curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1] =
3096 							curbuf->b_last_change;
3097 	/* The current window is always after the last change, so that "g,"
3098 	 * takes you back to it. */
3099 	curwin->w_changelistidx = curbuf->b_changelistlen;
3100 #endif
3101     }
3102 
3103     FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp)
3104     {
3105 	if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf)
3106 	{
3107 	    /* Mark this window to be redrawn later. */
3108 	    if (wp->w_redr_type < VALID)
3109 		wp->w_redr_type = VALID;
3110 
3111 	    /* Check if a change in the buffer has invalidated the cached
3112 	     * values for the cursor. */
3113 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
3114 	    /*
3115 	     * Update the folds for this window.  Can't postpone this, because
3116 	     * a following operator might work on the whole fold: ">>dd".
3117 	     */
3118 	    foldUpdate(wp, lnum, lnume + xtra - 1);
3119 
3120 	    /* The change may cause lines above or below the change to become
3121 	     * included in a fold.  Set lnum/lnume to the first/last line that
3122 	     * might be displayed differently.
3123 	     * Set w_cline_folded here as an efficient way to update it when
3124 	     * inserting lines just above a closed fold. */
3125 	    i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnum, &lnum, NULL, FALSE, NULL);
3126 	    if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum)
3127 		wp->w_cline_folded = i;
3128 	    i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnume, NULL, &lnume, FALSE, NULL);
3129 	    if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnume)
3130 		wp->w_cline_folded = i;
3131 
3132 	    /* If the changed line is in a range of previously folded lines,
3133 	     * compare with the first line in that range. */
3134 	    if (wp->w_cursor.lnum <= lnum)
3135 	    {
3136 		i = find_wl_entry(wp, lnum);
3137 		if (i >= 0 && wp->w_cursor.lnum > wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum)
3138 		    changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp);
3139 	    }
3140 #endif
3141 
3142 	    if (wp->w_cursor.lnum > lnum)
3143 		changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp);
3144 	    else if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum && wp->w_cursor.col >= col)
3145 		changed_cline_bef_curs_win(wp);
3146 	    if (wp->w_botline >= lnum)
3147 	    {
3148 		/* Assume that botline doesn't change (inserted lines make
3149 		 * other lines scroll down below botline). */
3150 		approximate_botline_win(wp);
3151 	    }
3152 
3153 	    /* Check if any w_lines[] entries have become invalid.
3154 	     * For entries below the change: Correct the lnums for
3155 	     * inserted/deleted lines.  Makes it possible to stop displaying
3156 	     * after the change. */
3157 	    for (i = 0; i < wp->w_lines_valid; ++i)
3158 		if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid)
3159 		{
3160 		    if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum >= lnum)
3161 		    {
3162 			if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum < lnume)
3163 			{
3164 			    /* line included in change */
3165 			    wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE;
3166 			}
3167 			else if (xtra != 0)
3168 			{
3169 			    /* line below change */
3170 			    wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum += xtra;
3171 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
3172 			    wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum += xtra;
3173 #endif
3174 			}
3175 		    }
3176 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
3177 		    else if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum >= lnum)
3178 		    {
3179 			/* change somewhere inside this range of folded lines,
3180 			 * may need to be redrawn */
3181 			wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE;
3182 		    }
3183 #endif
3184 		}
3185 
3186 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
3187 	    /* Take care of side effects for setting w_topline when folds have
3188 	     * changed.  Esp. when the buffer was changed in another window. */
3189 	    if (hasAnyFolding(wp))
3190 		set_topline(wp, wp->w_topline);
3191 #endif
3192 	    /* relative numbering may require updating more */
3193 	    if (wp->w_p_rnu)
3194 		redraw_win_later(wp, SOME_VALID);
3195 	}
3196     }
3197 
3198     /* Call update_screen() later, which checks out what needs to be redrawn,
3199      * since it notices b_mod_set and then uses b_mod_*. */
3200     if (must_redraw < VALID)
3201 	must_redraw = VALID;
3202 
3203 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
3204     /* when the cursor line is changed always trigger CursorMoved */
3205     if (lnum <= curwin->w_cursor.lnum
3206 		 && lnume + (xtra < 0 ? -xtra : xtra) > curwin->w_cursor.lnum)
3207 	last_cursormoved.lnum = 0;
3208 #endif
3209 }
3210 
3211 /*
3212  * unchanged() is called when the changed flag must be reset for buffer 'buf'
3213  */
3214     void
3215 unchanged(buf, ff)
3216     buf_T	*buf;
3217     int		ff;	/* also reset 'fileformat' */
3218 {
3219     if (buf->b_changed || (ff && file_ff_differs(buf, FALSE)))
3220     {
3221 	buf->b_changed = 0;
3222 	ml_setflags(buf);
3223 	if (ff)
3224 	    save_file_ff(buf);
3225 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
3226 	check_status(buf);
3227 	redraw_tabline = TRUE;
3228 #endif
3229 #ifdef FEAT_TITLE
3230 	need_maketitle = TRUE;	    /* set window title later */
3231 #endif
3232     }
3233     ++buf->b_changedtick;
3234 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG
3235     netbeans_unmodified(buf);
3236 #endif
3237 }
3238 
3239 #if defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) || defined(PROTO)
3240 /*
3241  * check_status: called when the status bars for the buffer 'buf'
3242  *		 need to be updated
3243  */
3244     void
3245 check_status(buf)
3246     buf_T	*buf;
3247 {
3248     win_T	*wp;
3249 
3250     for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next)
3251 	if (wp->w_buffer == buf && wp->w_status_height)
3252 	{
3253 	    wp->w_redr_status = TRUE;
3254 	    if (must_redraw < VALID)
3255 		must_redraw = VALID;
3256 	}
3257 }
3258 #endif
3259 
3260 /*
3261  * If the file is readonly, give a warning message with the first change.
3262  * Don't do this for autocommands.
3263  * Don't use emsg(), because it flushes the macro buffer.
3264  * If we have undone all changes b_changed will be FALSE, but "b_did_warn"
3265  * will be TRUE.
3266  * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer.
3267  */
3268     void
3269 change_warning(col)
3270     int	    col;		/* column for message; non-zero when in insert
3271 				   mode and 'showmode' is on */
3272 {
3273     static char *w_readonly = N_("W10: Warning: Changing a readonly file");
3274 
3275     if (curbuf->b_did_warn == FALSE
3276 	    && curbufIsChanged() == 0
3277 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
3278 	    && !autocmd_busy
3279 #endif
3280 	    && curbuf->b_p_ro)
3281     {
3282 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
3283 	++curbuf_lock;
3284 	apply_autocmds(EVENT_FILECHANGEDRO, NULL, NULL, FALSE, curbuf);
3285 	--curbuf_lock;
3286 	if (!curbuf->b_p_ro)
3287 	    return;
3288 #endif
3289 	/*
3290 	 * Do what msg() does, but with a column offset if the warning should
3291 	 * be after the mode message.
3292 	 */
3293 	msg_start();
3294 	if (msg_row == Rows - 1)
3295 	    msg_col = col;
3296 	msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W));
3297 	MSG_PUTS_ATTR(_(w_readonly), hl_attr(HLF_W) | MSG_HIST);
3298 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
3299 	set_vim_var_string(VV_WARNINGMSG, (char_u *)_(w_readonly), -1);
3300 #endif
3301 	msg_clr_eos();
3302 	(void)msg_end();
3303 	if (msg_silent == 0 && !silent_mode)
3304 	{
3305 	    out_flush();
3306 	    ui_delay(1000L, TRUE); /* give the user time to think about it */
3307 	}
3308 	curbuf->b_did_warn = TRUE;
3309 	redraw_cmdline = FALSE;	/* don't redraw and erase the message */
3310 	if (msg_row < Rows - 1)
3311 	    showmode();
3312     }
3313 }
3314 
3315 /*
3316  * Ask for a reply from the user, a 'y' or a 'n'.
3317  * No other characters are accepted, the message is repeated until a valid
3318  * reply is entered or CTRL-C is hit.
3319  * If direct is TRUE, don't use vgetc() but ui_inchar(), don't get characters
3320  * from any buffers but directly from the user.
3321  *
3322  * return the 'y' or 'n'
3323  */
3324     int
3325 ask_yesno(str, direct)
3326     char_u  *str;
3327     int	    direct;
3328 {
3329     int	    r = ' ';
3330     int	    save_State = State;
3331 
3332     if (exiting)		/* put terminal in raw mode for this question */
3333 	settmode(TMODE_RAW);
3334     ++no_wait_return;
3335 #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL
3336     dont_scroll = TRUE;		/* disallow scrolling here */
3337 #endif
3338     State = CONFIRM;		/* mouse behaves like with :confirm */
3339 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE
3340     setmouse();			/* disables mouse for xterm */
3341 #endif
3342     ++no_mapping;
3343     ++allow_keys;		/* no mapping here, but recognize keys */
3344 
3345     while (r != 'y' && r != 'n')
3346     {
3347 	/* same highlighting as for wait_return */
3348 	smsg_attr(hl_attr(HLF_R), (char_u *)"%s (y/n)?", str);
3349 	if (direct)
3350 	    r = get_keystroke();
3351 	else
3352 	    r = plain_vgetc();
3353 	if (r == Ctrl_C || r == ESC)
3354 	    r = 'n';
3355 	msg_putchar(r);	    /* show what you typed */
3356 	out_flush();
3357     }
3358     --no_wait_return;
3359     State = save_State;
3360 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE
3361     setmouse();
3362 #endif
3363     --no_mapping;
3364     --allow_keys;
3365 
3366     return r;
3367 }
3368 
3369 #if defined(FEAT_MOUSE) || defined(PROTO)
3370 /*
3371  * Return TRUE if "c" is a mouse key.
3372  */
3373     int
3374 is_mouse_key(c)
3375     int c;
3376 {
3377     return c == K_LEFTMOUSE
3378 	|| c == K_LEFTMOUSE_NM
3379 	|| c == K_LEFTDRAG
3380 	|| c == K_LEFTRELEASE
3381 	|| c == K_LEFTRELEASE_NM
3382 	|| c == K_MIDDLEMOUSE
3383 	|| c == K_MIDDLEDRAG
3384 	|| c == K_MIDDLERELEASE
3385 	|| c == K_RIGHTMOUSE
3386 	|| c == K_RIGHTDRAG
3387 	|| c == K_RIGHTRELEASE
3388 	|| c == K_MOUSEDOWN
3389 	|| c == K_MOUSEUP
3390 	|| c == K_MOUSELEFT
3391 	|| c == K_MOUSERIGHT
3392 	|| c == K_X1MOUSE
3393 	|| c == K_X1DRAG
3394 	|| c == K_X1RELEASE
3395 	|| c == K_X2MOUSE
3396 	|| c == K_X2DRAG
3397 	|| c == K_X2RELEASE;
3398 }
3399 #endif
3400 
3401 /*
3402  * Get a key stroke directly from the user.
3403  * Ignores mouse clicks and scrollbar events, except a click for the left
3404  * button (used at the more prompt).
3405  * Doesn't use vgetc(), because it syncs undo and eats mapped characters.
3406  * Disadvantage: typeahead is ignored.
3407  * Translates the interrupt character for unix to ESC.
3408  */
3409     int
3410 get_keystroke()
3411 {
3412     char_u	*buf = NULL;
3413     int		buflen = 150;
3414     int		maxlen;
3415     int		len = 0;
3416     int		n;
3417     int		save_mapped_ctrl_c = mapped_ctrl_c;
3418     int		waited = 0;
3419 
3420     mapped_ctrl_c = FALSE;	/* mappings are not used here */
3421     for (;;)
3422     {
3423 	cursor_on();
3424 	out_flush();
3425 
3426 	/* Leave some room for check_termcode() to insert a key code into (max
3427 	 * 5 chars plus NUL).  And fix_input_buffer() can triple the number of
3428 	 * bytes. */
3429 	maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3;
3430 	if (buf == NULL)
3431 	    buf = alloc(buflen);
3432 	else if (maxlen < 10)
3433 	{
3434 	    char_u  *t_buf = buf;
3435 
3436 	    /* Need some more space. This might happen when receiving a long
3437 	     * escape sequence. */
3438 	    buflen += 100;
3439 	    buf = vim_realloc(buf, buflen);
3440 	    if (buf == NULL)
3441 		vim_free(t_buf);
3442 	    maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3;
3443 	}
3444 	if (buf == NULL)
3445 	{
3446 	    do_outofmem_msg((long_u)buflen);
3447 	    return ESC;  /* panic! */
3448 	}
3449 
3450 	/* First time: blocking wait.  Second time: wait up to 100ms for a
3451 	 * terminal code to complete. */
3452 	n = ui_inchar(buf + len, maxlen, len == 0 ? -1L : 100L, 0);
3453 	if (n > 0)
3454 	{
3455 	    /* Replace zero and CSI by a special key code. */
3456 	    n = fix_input_buffer(buf + len, n, FALSE);
3457 	    len += n;
3458 	    waited = 0;
3459 	}
3460 	else if (len > 0)
3461 	    ++waited;	    /* keep track of the waiting time */
3462 
3463 	/* Incomplete termcode and not timed out yet: get more characters */
3464 	if ((n = check_termcode(1, buf, buflen, &len)) < 0
3465 	       && (!p_ttimeout || waited * 100L < (p_ttm < 0 ? p_tm : p_ttm)))
3466 	    continue;
3467 
3468 	if (n == KEYLEN_REMOVED)  /* key code removed */
3469 	{
3470 	    if (must_redraw != 0 && !need_wait_return && (State & CMDLINE) == 0)
3471 	    {
3472 		/* Redrawing was postponed, do it now. */
3473 		update_screen(0);
3474 		setcursor(); /* put cursor back where it belongs */
3475 	    }
3476 	    continue;
3477 	}
3478 	if (n > 0)		/* found a termcode: adjust length */
3479 	    len = n;
3480 	if (len == 0)		/* nothing typed yet */
3481 	    continue;
3482 
3483 	/* Handle modifier and/or special key code. */
3484 	n = buf[0];
3485 	if (n == K_SPECIAL)
3486 	{
3487 	    n = TO_SPECIAL(buf[1], buf[2]);
3488 	    if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER
3489 		    || n == K_IGNORE
3490 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE
3491 		    || (is_mouse_key(n) && n != K_LEFTMOUSE)
3492 #endif
3493 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
3494 		    || n == K_VER_SCROLLBAR
3495 		    || n == K_HOR_SCROLLBAR
3496 #endif
3497 	       )
3498 	    {
3499 		if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER)
3500 		    mod_mask = buf[2];
3501 		len -= 3;
3502 		if (len > 0)
3503 		    mch_memmove(buf, buf + 3, (size_t)len);
3504 		continue;
3505 	    }
3506 	    break;
3507 	}
3508 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
3509 	if (has_mbyte)
3510 	{
3511 	    if (MB_BYTE2LEN(n) > len)
3512 		continue;	/* more bytes to get */
3513 	    buf[len >= buflen ? buflen - 1 : len] = NUL;
3514 	    n = (*mb_ptr2char)(buf);
3515 	}
3516 #endif
3517 #ifdef UNIX
3518 	if (n == intr_char)
3519 	    n = ESC;
3520 #endif
3521 	break;
3522     }
3523     vim_free(buf);
3524 
3525     mapped_ctrl_c = save_mapped_ctrl_c;
3526     return n;
3527 }
3528 
3529 /*
3530  * Get a number from the user.
3531  * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse.
3532  */
3533     int
3534 get_number(colon, mouse_used)
3535     int	    colon;			/* allow colon to abort */
3536     int	    *mouse_used;
3537 {
3538     int	n = 0;
3539     int	c;
3540     int typed = 0;
3541 
3542     if (mouse_used != NULL)
3543 	*mouse_used = FALSE;
3544 
3545     /* When not printing messages, the user won't know what to type, return a
3546      * zero (as if CR was hit). */
3547     if (msg_silent != 0)
3548 	return 0;
3549 
3550 #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL
3551     dont_scroll = TRUE;		/* disallow scrolling here */
3552 #endif
3553     ++no_mapping;
3554     ++allow_keys;		/* no mapping here, but recognize keys */
3555     for (;;)
3556     {
3557 	windgoto(msg_row, msg_col);
3558 	c = safe_vgetc();
3559 	if (VIM_ISDIGIT(c))
3560 	{
3561 	    n = n * 10 + c - '0';
3562 	    msg_putchar(c);
3563 	    ++typed;
3564 	}
3565 	else if (c == K_DEL || c == K_KDEL || c == K_BS || c == Ctrl_H)
3566 	{
3567 	    if (typed > 0)
3568 	    {
3569 		MSG_PUTS("\b \b");
3570 		--typed;
3571 	    }
3572 	    n /= 10;
3573 	}
3574 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE
3575 	else if (mouse_used != NULL && c == K_LEFTMOUSE)
3576 	{
3577 	    *mouse_used = TRUE;
3578 	    n = mouse_row + 1;
3579 	    break;
3580 	}
3581 #endif
3582 	else if (n == 0 && c == ':' && colon)
3583 	{
3584 	    stuffcharReadbuff(':');
3585 	    if (!exmode_active)
3586 		cmdline_row = msg_row;
3587 	    skip_redraw = TRUE;	    /* skip redraw once */
3588 	    do_redraw = FALSE;
3589 	    break;
3590 	}
3591 	else if (c == CAR || c == NL || c == Ctrl_C || c == ESC)
3592 	    break;
3593     }
3594     --no_mapping;
3595     --allow_keys;
3596     return n;
3597 }
3598 
3599 /*
3600  * Ask the user to enter a number.
3601  * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse and in that case return
3602  * the line number.
3603  */
3604     int
3605 prompt_for_number(mouse_used)
3606     int		*mouse_used;
3607 {
3608     int		i;
3609     int		save_cmdline_row;
3610     int		save_State;
3611 
3612     /* When using ":silent" assume that <CR> was entered. */
3613     if (mouse_used != NULL)
3614 	MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> or click with mouse (empty cancels): "));
3615     else
3616 	MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> (empty cancels): "));
3617 
3618     /* Set the state such that text can be selected/copied/pasted and we still
3619      * get mouse events. */
3620     save_cmdline_row = cmdline_row;
3621     cmdline_row = 0;
3622     save_State = State;
3623     State = CMDLINE;
3624 
3625     i = get_number(TRUE, mouse_used);
3626     if (KeyTyped)
3627     {
3628 	/* don't call wait_return() now */
3629 	/* msg_putchar('\n'); */
3630 	cmdline_row = msg_row - 1;
3631 	need_wait_return = FALSE;
3632 	msg_didany = FALSE;
3633 	msg_didout = FALSE;
3634     }
3635     else
3636 	cmdline_row = save_cmdline_row;
3637     State = save_State;
3638 
3639     return i;
3640 }
3641 
3642     void
3643 msgmore(n)
3644     long n;
3645 {
3646     long pn;
3647 
3648     if (global_busy	    /* no messages now, wait until global is finished */
3649 	    || !messaging())  /* 'lazyredraw' set, don't do messages now */
3650 	return;
3651 
3652     /* We don't want to overwrite another important message, but do overwrite
3653      * a previous "more lines" or "fewer lines" message, so that "5dd" and
3654      * then "put" reports the last action. */
3655     if (keep_msg != NULL && !keep_msg_more)
3656 	return;
3657 
3658     if (n > 0)
3659 	pn = n;
3660     else
3661 	pn = -n;
3662 
3663     if (pn > p_report)
3664     {
3665 	if (pn == 1)
3666 	{
3667 	    if (n > 0)
3668 		vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 more line"),
3669 							     MSG_BUF_LEN - 1);
3670 	    else
3671 		vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 line less"),
3672 							     MSG_BUF_LEN - 1);
3673 	}
3674 	else
3675 	{
3676 	    if (n > 0)
3677 		vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN,
3678 						     _("%ld more lines"), pn);
3679 	    else
3680 		vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN,
3681 						    _("%ld fewer lines"), pn);
3682 	}
3683 	if (got_int)
3684 	    vim_strcat(msg_buf, (char_u *)_(" (Interrupted)"), MSG_BUF_LEN);
3685 	if (msg(msg_buf))
3686 	{
3687 	    set_keep_msg(msg_buf, 0);
3688 	    keep_msg_more = TRUE;
3689 	}
3690     }
3691 }
3692 
3693 /*
3694  * flush map and typeahead buffers and give a warning for an error
3695  */
3696     void
3697 beep_flush()
3698 {
3699     if (emsg_silent == 0)
3700     {
3701 	flush_buffers(FALSE);
3702 	vim_beep(BO_ERROR);
3703     }
3704 }
3705 
3706 /*
3707  * Give a warning for an error.
3708  */
3709     void
3710 vim_beep(val)
3711     unsigned val; /* one of the BO_ values, e.g., BO_OPER */
3712 {
3713     if (emsg_silent == 0)
3714     {
3715 	if (!((bo_flags & val) || (bo_flags & BO_ALL)))
3716 	{
3717 	    if (p_vb
3718 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
3719 		    /* While the GUI is starting up the termcap is set for the
3720 		     * GUI but the output still goes to a terminal. */
3721 		    && !(gui.in_use && gui.starting)
3722 #endif
3723 		    )
3724 	    {
3725 		out_str(T_VB);
3726 	    }
3727 	    else
3728 	    {
3729 #ifdef MSDOS
3730 		/*
3731 		 * The number of beeps outputted is reduced to avoid having to
3732 		 * wait for all the beeps to finish. This is only a problem on
3733 		 * systems where the beeps don't overlap.
3734 		 */
3735 		if (beep_count == 0 || beep_count == 10)
3736 		{
3737 		    out_char(BELL);
3738 		    beep_count = 1;
3739 		}
3740 		else
3741 		    ++beep_count;
3742 #else
3743 		out_char(BELL);
3744 #endif
3745 	    }
3746 	}
3747 
3748 	/* When 'verbose' is set and we are sourcing a script or executing a
3749 	 * function give the user a hint where the beep comes from. */
3750 	if (vim_strchr(p_debug, 'e') != NULL)
3751 	{
3752 	    msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W));
3753 	    msg_attr((char_u *)_("Beep!"), hl_attr(HLF_W));
3754 	}
3755     }
3756 }
3757 
3758 /*
3759  * To get the "real" home directory:
3760  * - get value of $HOME
3761  * For Unix:
3762  *  - go to that directory
3763  *  - do mch_dirname() to get the real name of that directory.
3764  *  This also works with mounts and links.
3765  *  Don't do this for MS-DOS, it will change the "current dir" for a drive.
3766  */
3767 static char_u	*homedir = NULL;
3768 
3769     void
3770 init_homedir()
3771 {
3772     char_u  *var;
3773 
3774     /* In case we are called a second time (when 'encoding' changes). */
3775     vim_free(homedir);
3776     homedir = NULL;
3777 
3778 #ifdef VMS
3779     var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN");
3780 #else
3781     var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME");
3782 #endif
3783 
3784     if (var != NULL && *var == NUL)	/* empty is same as not set */
3785 	var = NULL;
3786 
3787 #ifdef WIN3264
3788     /*
3789      * Weird but true: $HOME may contain an indirect reference to another
3790      * variable, esp. "%USERPROFILE%".  Happens when $USERPROFILE isn't set
3791      * when $HOME is being set.
3792      */
3793     if (var != NULL && *var == '%')
3794     {
3795 	char_u	*p;
3796 	char_u	*exp;
3797 
3798 	p = vim_strchr(var + 1, '%');
3799 	if (p != NULL)
3800 	{
3801 	    vim_strncpy(NameBuff, var + 1, p - (var + 1));
3802 	    exp = mch_getenv(NameBuff);
3803 	    if (exp != NULL && *exp != NUL
3804 					&& STRLEN(exp) + STRLEN(p) < MAXPATHL)
3805 	    {
3806 		vim_snprintf((char *)NameBuff, MAXPATHL, "%s%s", exp, p + 1);
3807 		var = NameBuff;
3808 		/* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */
3809 		vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff);
3810 	    }
3811 	}
3812     }
3813 
3814     /*
3815      * Typically, $HOME is not defined on Windows, unless the user has
3816      * specifically defined it for Vim's sake.  However, on Windows NT
3817      * platforms, $HOMEDRIVE and $HOMEPATH are automatically defined for
3818      * each user.  Try constructing $HOME from these.
3819      */
3820     if (var == NULL)
3821     {
3822 	char_u *homedrive, *homepath;
3823 
3824 	homedrive = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEDRIVE");
3825 	homepath = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEPATH");
3826 	if (homepath == NULL || *homepath == NUL)
3827 	    homepath = "\\";
3828 	if (homedrive != NULL
3829 			   && STRLEN(homedrive) + STRLEN(homepath) < MAXPATHL)
3830 	{
3831 	    sprintf((char *)NameBuff, "%s%s", homedrive, homepath);
3832 	    if (NameBuff[0] != NUL)
3833 	    {
3834 		var = NameBuff;
3835 		/* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */
3836 		vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff);
3837 	    }
3838 	}
3839     }
3840 
3841 # if defined(FEAT_MBYTE)
3842     if (enc_utf8 && var != NULL)
3843     {
3844 	int	len;
3845 	char_u  *pp = NULL;
3846 
3847 	/* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8.  Other conversions are
3848 	 * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */
3849 	acp_to_enc(var, (int)STRLEN(var), &pp, &len);
3850 	if (pp != NULL)
3851 	{
3852 	    homedir = pp;
3853 	    return;
3854 	}
3855     }
3856 # endif
3857 #endif
3858 
3859 #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN)
3860     /*
3861      * Default home dir is C:/
3862      * Best assumption we can make in such a situation.
3863      */
3864     if (var == NULL)
3865 	var = "C:/";
3866 #endif
3867     if (var != NULL)
3868     {
3869 #ifdef UNIX
3870 	/*
3871 	 * Change to the directory and get the actual path.  This resolves
3872 	 * links.  Don't do it when we can't return.
3873 	 */
3874 	if (mch_dirname(NameBuff, MAXPATHL) == OK
3875 					  && mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) == 0)
3876 	{
3877 	    if (!mch_chdir((char *)var) && mch_dirname(IObuff, IOSIZE) == OK)
3878 		var = IObuff;
3879 	    if (mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) != 0)
3880 		EMSG(_(e_prev_dir));
3881 	}
3882 #endif
3883 	homedir = vim_strsave(var);
3884     }
3885 }
3886 
3887 #if defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO)
3888     void
3889 free_homedir()
3890 {
3891     vim_free(homedir);
3892 }
3893 
3894 # ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
3895     void
3896 free_users()
3897 {
3898     ga_clear_strings(&ga_users);
3899 }
3900 # endif
3901 #endif
3902 
3903 /*
3904  * Call expand_env() and store the result in an allocated string.
3905  * This is not very memory efficient, this expects the result to be freed
3906  * again soon.
3907  */
3908     char_u *
3909 expand_env_save(src)
3910     char_u	*src;
3911 {
3912     return expand_env_save_opt(src, FALSE);
3913 }
3914 
3915 /*
3916  * Idem, but when "one" is TRUE handle the string as one file name, only
3917  * expand "~" at the start.
3918  */
3919     char_u *
3920 expand_env_save_opt(src, one)
3921     char_u	*src;
3922     int		one;
3923 {
3924     char_u	*p;
3925 
3926     p = alloc(MAXPATHL);
3927     if (p != NULL)
3928 	expand_env_esc(src, p, MAXPATHL, FALSE, one, NULL);
3929     return p;
3930 }
3931 
3932 /*
3933  * Expand environment variable with path name.
3934  * "~/" is also expanded, using $HOME.	For Unix "~user/" is expanded.
3935  * Skips over "\ ", "\~" and "\$" (not for Win32 though).
3936  * If anything fails no expansion is done and dst equals src.
3937  */
3938     void
3939 expand_env(src, dst, dstlen)
3940     char_u	*src;		/* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */
3941     char_u	*dst;		/* where to put the result */
3942     int		dstlen;		/* maximum length of the result */
3943 {
3944     expand_env_esc(src, dst, dstlen, FALSE, FALSE, NULL);
3945 }
3946 
3947     void
3948 expand_env_esc(srcp, dst, dstlen, esc, one, startstr)
3949     char_u	*srcp;		/* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */
3950     char_u	*dst;		/* where to put the result */
3951     int		dstlen;		/* maximum length of the result */
3952     int		esc;		/* escape spaces in expanded variables */
3953     int		one;		/* "srcp" is one file name */
3954     char_u	*startstr;	/* start again after this (can be NULL) */
3955 {
3956     char_u	*src;
3957     char_u	*tail;
3958     int		c;
3959     char_u	*var;
3960     int		copy_char;
3961     int		mustfree;	/* var was allocated, need to free it later */
3962     int		at_start = TRUE; /* at start of a name */
3963     int		startstr_len = 0;
3964 
3965     if (startstr != NULL)
3966 	startstr_len = (int)STRLEN(startstr);
3967 
3968     src = skipwhite(srcp);
3969     --dstlen;		    /* leave one char space for "\," */
3970     while (*src && dstlen > 0)
3971     {
3972 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
3973 	/* Skip over `=expr`. */
3974 	if (src[0] == '`' && src[1] == '=')
3975 	{
3976 	    size_t len;
3977 
3978 	    var = src;
3979 	    src += 2;
3980 	    (void)skip_expr(&src);
3981 	    if (*src == '`')
3982 		++src;
3983 	    len = src - var;
3984 	    if (len > (size_t)dstlen)
3985 		len = dstlen;
3986 	    vim_strncpy(dst, var, len);
3987 	    dst += len;
3988 	    dstlen -= (int)len;
3989 	    continue;
3990 	}
3991 #endif
3992 	copy_char = TRUE;
3993 	if ((*src == '$'
3994 #ifdef VMS
3995 		    && at_start
3996 #endif
3997 	   )
3998 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2)
3999 		|| *src == '%'
4000 #endif
4001 		|| (*src == '~' && at_start))
4002 	{
4003 	    mustfree = FALSE;
4004 
4005 	    /*
4006 	     * The variable name is copied into dst temporarily, because it may
4007 	     * be a string in read-only memory and a NUL needs to be appended.
4008 	     */
4009 	    if (*src != '~')				/* environment var */
4010 	    {
4011 		tail = src + 1;
4012 		var = dst;
4013 		c = dstlen - 1;
4014 
4015 #ifdef UNIX
4016 		/* Unix has ${var-name} type environment vars */
4017 		if (*tail == '{' && !vim_isIDc('{'))
4018 		{
4019 		    tail++;	/* ignore '{' */
4020 		    while (c-- > 0 && *tail && *tail != '}')
4021 			*var++ = *tail++;
4022 		}
4023 		else
4024 #endif
4025 		{
4026 		    while (c-- > 0 && *tail != NUL && ((vim_isIDc(*tail))
4027 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2)
4028 			    || (*src == '%' && *tail != '%')
4029 #endif
4030 			    ))
4031 		    {
4032 #ifdef OS2		/* env vars only in uppercase */
4033 			*var++ = TOUPPER_LOC(*tail);
4034 			tail++;	    /* toupper() may be a macro! */
4035 #else
4036 			*var++ = *tail++;
4037 #endif
4038 		    }
4039 		}
4040 
4041 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX)
4042 # ifdef UNIX
4043 		if (src[1] == '{' && *tail != '}')
4044 # else
4045 		if (*src == '%' && *tail != '%')
4046 # endif
4047 		    var = NULL;
4048 		else
4049 		{
4050 # ifdef UNIX
4051 		    if (src[1] == '{')
4052 # else
4053 		    if (*src == '%')
4054 #endif
4055 			++tail;
4056 #endif
4057 		    *var = NUL;
4058 		    var = vim_getenv(dst, &mustfree);
4059 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX)
4060 		}
4061 #endif
4062 	    }
4063 							/* home directory */
4064 	    else if (  src[1] == NUL
4065 		    || vim_ispathsep(src[1])
4066 		    || vim_strchr((char_u *)" ,\t\n", src[1]) != NULL)
4067 	    {
4068 		var = homedir;
4069 		tail = src + 1;
4070 	    }
4071 	    else					/* user directory */
4072 	    {
4073 #if defined(UNIX) || (defined(VMS) && defined(USER_HOME))
4074 		/*
4075 		 * Copy ~user to dst[], so we can put a NUL after it.
4076 		 */
4077 		tail = src;
4078 		var = dst;
4079 		c = dstlen - 1;
4080 		while (	   c-- > 0
4081 			&& *tail
4082 			&& vim_isfilec(*tail)
4083 			&& !vim_ispathsep(*tail))
4084 		    *var++ = *tail++;
4085 		*var = NUL;
4086 # ifdef UNIX
4087 		/*
4088 		 * If the system supports getpwnam(), use it.
4089 		 * Otherwise, or if getpwnam() fails, the shell is used to
4090 		 * expand ~user.  This is slower and may fail if the shell
4091 		 * does not support ~user (old versions of /bin/sh).
4092 		 */
4093 #  if defined(HAVE_GETPWNAM) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H)
4094 		{
4095 		    struct passwd *pw;
4096 
4097 		    /* Note: memory allocated by getpwnam() is never freed.
4098 		     * Calling endpwent() apparently doesn't help. */
4099 		    pw = getpwnam((char *)dst + 1);
4100 		    if (pw != NULL)
4101 			var = (char_u *)pw->pw_dir;
4102 		    else
4103 			var = NULL;
4104 		}
4105 		if (var == NULL)
4106 #  endif
4107 		{
4108 		    expand_T	xpc;
4109 
4110 		    ExpandInit(&xpc);
4111 		    xpc.xp_context = EXPAND_FILES;
4112 		    var = ExpandOne(&xpc, dst, NULL,
4113 				WILD_ADD_SLASH|WILD_SILENT, WILD_EXPAND_FREE);
4114 		    mustfree = TRUE;
4115 		}
4116 
4117 # else	/* !UNIX, thus VMS */
4118 		/*
4119 		 * USER_HOME is a comma-separated list of
4120 		 * directories to search for the user account in.
4121 		 */
4122 		{
4123 		    char_u	test[MAXPATHL], paths[MAXPATHL];
4124 		    char_u	*path, *next_path, *ptr;
4125 		    struct stat	st;
4126 
4127 		    STRCPY(paths, USER_HOME);
4128 		    next_path = paths;
4129 		    while (*next_path)
4130 		    {
4131 			for (path = next_path; *next_path && *next_path != ',';
4132 				next_path++);
4133 			if (*next_path)
4134 			    *next_path++ = NUL;
4135 			STRCPY(test, path);
4136 			STRCAT(test, "/");
4137 			STRCAT(test, dst + 1);
4138 			if (mch_stat(test, &st) == 0)
4139 			{
4140 			    var = alloc(STRLEN(test) + 1);
4141 			    STRCPY(var, test);
4142 			    mustfree = TRUE;
4143 			    break;
4144 			}
4145 		    }
4146 		}
4147 # endif /* UNIX */
4148 #else
4149 		/* cannot expand user's home directory, so don't try */
4150 		var = NULL;
4151 		tail = (char_u *)"";	/* for gcc */
4152 #endif /* UNIX || VMS */
4153 	    }
4154 
4155 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
4156 	    /* If 'shellslash' is set change backslashes to forward slashes.
4157 	     * Can't use slash_adjust(), p_ssl may be set temporarily. */
4158 	    if (p_ssl && var != NULL && vim_strchr(var, '\\') != NULL)
4159 	    {
4160 		char_u	*p = vim_strsave(var);
4161 
4162 		if (p != NULL)
4163 		{
4164 		    if (mustfree)
4165 			vim_free(var);
4166 		    var = p;
4167 		    mustfree = TRUE;
4168 		    forward_slash(var);
4169 		}
4170 	    }
4171 #endif
4172 
4173 	    /* If "var" contains white space, escape it with a backslash.
4174 	     * Required for ":e ~/tt" when $HOME includes a space. */
4175 	    if (esc && var != NULL && vim_strpbrk(var, (char_u *)" \t") != NULL)
4176 	    {
4177 		char_u	*p = vim_strsave_escaped(var, (char_u *)" \t");
4178 
4179 		if (p != NULL)
4180 		{
4181 		    if (mustfree)
4182 			vim_free(var);
4183 		    var = p;
4184 		    mustfree = TRUE;
4185 		}
4186 	    }
4187 
4188 	    if (var != NULL && *var != NUL
4189 		    && (STRLEN(var) + STRLEN(tail) + 1 < (unsigned)dstlen))
4190 	    {
4191 		STRCPY(dst, var);
4192 		dstlen -= (int)STRLEN(var);
4193 		c = (int)STRLEN(var);
4194 		/* if var[] ends in a path separator and tail[] starts
4195 		 * with it, skip a character */
4196 		if (*var != NUL && after_pathsep(dst, dst + c)
4197 #if defined(BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME) || defined(AMIGA)
4198 			&& dst[-1] != ':'
4199 #endif
4200 			&& vim_ispathsep(*tail))
4201 		    ++tail;
4202 		dst += c;
4203 		src = tail;
4204 		copy_char = FALSE;
4205 	    }
4206 	    if (mustfree)
4207 		vim_free(var);
4208 	}
4209 
4210 	if (copy_char)	    /* copy at least one char */
4211 	{
4212 	    /*
4213 	     * Recognize the start of a new name, for '~'.
4214 	     * Don't do this when "one" is TRUE, to avoid expanding "~" in
4215 	     * ":edit foo ~ foo".
4216 	     */
4217 	    at_start = FALSE;
4218 	    if (src[0] == '\\' && src[1] != NUL)
4219 	    {
4220 		*dst++ = *src++;
4221 		--dstlen;
4222 	    }
4223 	    else if ((src[0] == ' ' || src[0] == ',') && !one)
4224 		at_start = TRUE;
4225 	    *dst++ = *src++;
4226 	    --dstlen;
4227 
4228 	    if (startstr != NULL && src - startstr_len >= srcp
4229 		    && STRNCMP(src - startstr_len, startstr, startstr_len) == 0)
4230 		at_start = TRUE;
4231 	}
4232     }
4233     *dst = NUL;
4234 }
4235 
4236 /*
4237  * Vim's version of getenv().
4238  * Special handling of $HOME, $VIM and $VIMRUNTIME.
4239  * Also does ACP to 'enc' conversion for Win32.
4240  * "mustfree" is set to TRUE when returned is allocated, it must be
4241  * initialized to FALSE by the caller.
4242  */
4243     char_u *
4244 vim_getenv(name, mustfree)
4245     char_u	*name;
4246     int		*mustfree;
4247 {
4248     char_u	*p;
4249     char_u	*pend;
4250     int		vimruntime;
4251 
4252 #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN)
4253     /* use "C:/" when $HOME is not set */
4254     if (STRCMP(name, "HOME") == 0)
4255 	return homedir;
4256 #endif
4257 
4258     p = mch_getenv(name);
4259     if (p != NULL && *p == NUL)	    /* empty is the same as not set */
4260 	p = NULL;
4261 
4262     if (p != NULL)
4263     {
4264 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264)
4265 	if (enc_utf8)
4266 	{
4267 	    int	    len;
4268 	    char_u  *pp = NULL;
4269 
4270 	    /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8.  Other conversions are
4271 	     * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */
4272 	    acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len);
4273 	    if (pp != NULL)
4274 	    {
4275 		p = pp;
4276 		*mustfree = TRUE;
4277 	    }
4278 	}
4279 #endif
4280 	return p;
4281     }
4282 
4283     vimruntime = (STRCMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0);
4284     if (!vimruntime && STRCMP(name, "VIM") != 0)
4285 	return NULL;
4286 
4287     /*
4288      * When expanding $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using $VIM/vim<version> or $VIM.
4289      * Don't do this when default_vimruntime_dir is non-empty.
4290      */
4291     if (vimruntime
4292 #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF
4293 	    && *default_vimruntime_dir == NUL
4294 #endif
4295        )
4296     {
4297 	p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM");
4298 	if (p != NULL && *p == NUL)	    /* empty is the same as not set */
4299 	    p = NULL;
4300 	if (p != NULL)
4301 	{
4302 	    p = vim_version_dir(p);
4303 	    if (p != NULL)
4304 		*mustfree = TRUE;
4305 	    else
4306 		p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM");
4307 
4308 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264)
4309 	    if (enc_utf8)
4310 	    {
4311 		int	len;
4312 		char_u  *pp = NULL;
4313 
4314 		/* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8.  Other conversions
4315 		 * are not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII
4316 		 * characters. */
4317 		acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len);
4318 		if (pp != NULL)
4319 		{
4320 		    if (*mustfree)
4321 			vim_free(p);
4322 		    p = pp;
4323 		    *mustfree = TRUE;
4324 		}
4325 	    }
4326 #endif
4327 	}
4328     }
4329 
4330     /*
4331      * When expanding $VIM or $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using:
4332      * - the directory name from 'helpfile' (unless it contains '$')
4333      * - the executable name from argv[0]
4334      */
4335     if (p == NULL)
4336     {
4337 	if (p_hf != NULL && vim_strchr(p_hf, '$') == NULL)
4338 	    p = p_hf;
4339 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
4340 	/*
4341 	 * Use the name of the executable, obtained from argv[0].
4342 	 */
4343 	else
4344 	    p = exe_name;
4345 #endif
4346 	if (p != NULL)
4347 	{
4348 	    /* remove the file name */
4349 	    pend = gettail(p);
4350 
4351 	    /* remove "doc/" from 'helpfile', if present */
4352 	    if (p == p_hf)
4353 		pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"doc");
4354 
4355 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
4356 # ifdef MACOS_X
4357 	    /* remove "MacOS" from exe_name and add "Resources/vim" */
4358 	    if (p == exe_name)
4359 	    {
4360 		char_u	*pend1;
4361 		char_u	*pnew;
4362 
4363 		pend1 = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"MacOS");
4364 		if (pend1 != pend)
4365 		{
4366 		    pnew = alloc((unsigned)(pend1 - p) + 15);
4367 		    if (pnew != NULL)
4368 		    {
4369 			STRNCPY(pnew, p, (pend1 - p));
4370 			STRCPY(pnew + (pend1 - p), "Resources/vim");
4371 			p = pnew;
4372 			pend = p + STRLEN(p);
4373 		    }
4374 		}
4375 	    }
4376 # endif
4377 	    /* remove "src/" from exe_name, if present */
4378 	    if (p == exe_name)
4379 		pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"src");
4380 #endif
4381 
4382 	    /* for $VIM, remove "runtime/" or "vim54/", if present */
4383 	    if (!vimruntime)
4384 	    {
4385 		pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME);
4386 		pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT);
4387 	    }
4388 
4389 	    /* remove trailing path separator */
4390 #ifndef MACOS_CLASSIC
4391 	    /* With MacOS path (with  colons) the final colon is required */
4392 	    /* to avoid confusion between absolute and relative path */
4393 	    if (pend > p && after_pathsep(p, pend))
4394 		--pend;
4395 #endif
4396 
4397 #ifdef MACOS_X
4398 	    if (p == exe_name || p == p_hf)
4399 #endif
4400 		/* check that the result is a directory name */
4401 		p = vim_strnsave(p, (int)(pend - p));
4402 
4403 	    if (p != NULL && !mch_isdir(p))
4404 	    {
4405 		vim_free(p);
4406 		p = NULL;
4407 	    }
4408 	    else
4409 	    {
4410 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
4411 		/* may add "/vim54" or "/runtime" if it exists */
4412 		if (vimruntime && (pend = vim_version_dir(p)) != NULL)
4413 		{
4414 		    vim_free(p);
4415 		    p = pend;
4416 		}
4417 #endif
4418 		*mustfree = TRUE;
4419 	    }
4420 	}
4421     }
4422 
4423 #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF
4424     /* When there is a pathdef.c file we can use default_vim_dir and
4425      * default_vimruntime_dir */
4426     if (p == NULL)
4427     {
4428 	/* Only use default_vimruntime_dir when it is not empty */
4429 	if (vimruntime && *default_vimruntime_dir != NUL)
4430 	{
4431 	    p = default_vimruntime_dir;
4432 	    *mustfree = FALSE;
4433 	}
4434 	else if (*default_vim_dir != NUL)
4435 	{
4436 	    if (vimruntime && (p = vim_version_dir(default_vim_dir)) != NULL)
4437 		*mustfree = TRUE;
4438 	    else
4439 	    {
4440 		p = default_vim_dir;
4441 		*mustfree = FALSE;
4442 	    }
4443 	}
4444     }
4445 #endif
4446 
4447     /*
4448      * Set the environment variable, so that the new value can be found fast
4449      * next time, and others can also use it (e.g. Perl).
4450      */
4451     if (p != NULL)
4452     {
4453 	if (vimruntime)
4454 	{
4455 	    vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIMRUNTIME", p);
4456 	    didset_vimruntime = TRUE;
4457 	}
4458 	else
4459 	{
4460 	    vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIM", p);
4461 	    didset_vim = TRUE;
4462 	}
4463     }
4464     return p;
4465 }
4466 
4467 /*
4468  * Check if the directory "vimdir/<version>" or "vimdir/runtime" exists.
4469  * Return NULL if not, return its name in allocated memory otherwise.
4470  */
4471     static char_u *
4472 vim_version_dir(vimdir)
4473     char_u	*vimdir;
4474 {
4475     char_u	*p;
4476 
4477     if (vimdir == NULL || *vimdir == NUL)
4478 	return NULL;
4479     p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT, TRUE);
4480     if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p))
4481 	return p;
4482     vim_free(p);
4483     p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME, TRUE);
4484     if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p))
4485 	return p;
4486     vim_free(p);
4487     return NULL;
4488 }
4489 
4490 /*
4491  * If the string between "p" and "pend" ends in "name/", return "pend" minus
4492  * the length of "name/".  Otherwise return "pend".
4493  */
4494     static char_u *
4495 remove_tail(p, pend, name)
4496     char_u	*p;
4497     char_u	*pend;
4498     char_u	*name;
4499 {
4500     int		len = (int)STRLEN(name) + 1;
4501     char_u	*newend = pend - len;
4502 
4503     if (newend >= p
4504 	    && fnamencmp(newend, name, len - 1) == 0
4505 	    && (newend == p || after_pathsep(p, newend)))
4506 	return newend;
4507     return pend;
4508 }
4509 
4510 /*
4511  * Our portable version of setenv.
4512  */
4513     void
4514 vim_setenv(name, val)
4515     char_u	*name;
4516     char_u	*val;
4517 {
4518 #ifdef HAVE_SETENV
4519     mch_setenv((char *)name, (char *)val, 1);
4520 #else
4521     char_u	*envbuf;
4522 
4523     /*
4524      * Putenv does not copy the string, it has to remain
4525      * valid.  The allocated memory will never be freed.
4526      */
4527     envbuf = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(name) + STRLEN(val) + 2));
4528     if (envbuf != NULL)
4529     {
4530 	sprintf((char *)envbuf, "%s=%s", name, val);
4531 	putenv((char *)envbuf);
4532     }
4533 #endif
4534 #ifdef FEAT_GETTEXT
4535     /*
4536      * When setting $VIMRUNTIME adjust the directory to find message
4537      * translations to $VIMRUNTIME/lang.
4538      */
4539     if (*val != NUL && STRICMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0)
4540     {
4541 	char_u	*buf = concat_str(val, (char_u *)"/lang");
4542 
4543 	if (buf != NULL)
4544 	{
4545 	    bindtextdomain(VIMPACKAGE, (char *)buf);
4546 	    vim_free(buf);
4547 	}
4548     }
4549 #endif
4550 }
4551 
4552 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO)
4553 /*
4554  * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an environment variable name.
4555  */
4556     char_u *
4557 get_env_name(xp, idx)
4558     expand_T	*xp UNUSED;
4559     int		idx;
4560 {
4561 # if defined(AMIGA) || defined(__MRC__) || defined(__SC__)
4562     /*
4563      * No environ[] on the Amiga and on the Mac (using MPW).
4564      */
4565     return NULL;
4566 # else
4567 # ifndef __WIN32__
4568     /* Borland C++ 5.2 has this in a header file. */
4569     extern char		**environ;
4570 # endif
4571 # define ENVNAMELEN 100
4572     static char_u	name[ENVNAMELEN];
4573     char_u		*str;
4574     int			n;
4575 
4576     str = (char_u *)environ[idx];
4577     if (str == NULL)
4578 	return NULL;
4579 
4580     for (n = 0; n < ENVNAMELEN - 1; ++n)
4581     {
4582 	if (str[n] == '=' || str[n] == NUL)
4583 	    break;
4584 	name[n] = str[n];
4585     }
4586     name[n] = NUL;
4587     return name;
4588 # endif
4589 }
4590 
4591 /*
4592  * Find all user names for user completion.
4593  * Done only once and then cached.
4594  */
4595     static void
4596 init_users()
4597 {
4598     static int	lazy_init_done = FALSE;
4599 
4600     if (lazy_init_done)
4601 	return;
4602 
4603     lazy_init_done = TRUE;
4604     ga_init2(&ga_users, sizeof(char_u *), 20);
4605 
4606 # if defined(HAVE_GETPWENT) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H)
4607     {
4608 	char_u*		user;
4609 	struct passwd*	pw;
4610 
4611 	setpwent();
4612 	while ((pw = getpwent()) != NULL)
4613 	    /* pw->pw_name shouldn't be NULL but just in case... */
4614 	    if (pw->pw_name != NULL)
4615 	    {
4616 		if (ga_grow(&ga_users, 1) == FAIL)
4617 		    break;
4618 		user = vim_strsave((char_u*)pw->pw_name);
4619 		if (user == NULL)
4620 		    break;
4621 		((char_u **)(ga_users.ga_data))[ga_users.ga_len++] = user;
4622 	    }
4623 	endpwent();
4624     }
4625 # endif
4626 }
4627 
4628 /*
4629  * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an user names.
4630  */
4631     char_u*
4632 get_users(xp, idx)
4633     expand_T	*xp UNUSED;
4634     int		idx;
4635 {
4636     init_users();
4637     if (idx < ga_users.ga_len)
4638 	return ((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[idx];
4639     return NULL;
4640 }
4641 
4642 /*
4643  * Check whether name matches a user name. Return:
4644  * 0 if name does not match any user name.
4645  * 1 if name partially matches the beginning of a user name.
4646  * 2 is name fully matches a user name.
4647  */
4648 int match_user(name)
4649     char_u* name;
4650 {
4651     int i;
4652     int n = (int)STRLEN(name);
4653     int result = 0;
4654 
4655     init_users();
4656     for (i = 0; i < ga_users.ga_len; i++)
4657     {
4658 	if (STRCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name) == 0)
4659 	    return 2; /* full match */
4660 	if (STRNCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name, n) == 0)
4661 	    result = 1; /* partial match */
4662     }
4663     return result;
4664 }
4665 #endif
4666 
4667 /*
4668  * Replace home directory by "~" in each space or comma separated file name in
4669  * 'src'.
4670  * If anything fails (except when out of space) dst equals src.
4671  */
4672     void
4673 home_replace(buf, src, dst, dstlen, one)
4674     buf_T	*buf;	/* when not NULL, check for help files */
4675     char_u	*src;	/* input file name */
4676     char_u	*dst;	/* where to put the result */
4677     int		dstlen;	/* maximum length of the result */
4678     int		one;	/* if TRUE, only replace one file name, include
4679 			   spaces and commas in the file name. */
4680 {
4681     size_t	dirlen = 0, envlen = 0;
4682     size_t	len;
4683     char_u	*homedir_env, *homedir_env_orig;
4684     char_u	*p;
4685 
4686     if (src == NULL)
4687     {
4688 	*dst = NUL;
4689 	return;
4690     }
4691 
4692     /*
4693      * If the file is a help file, remove the path completely.
4694      */
4695     if (buf != NULL && buf->b_help)
4696     {
4697 	STRCPY(dst, gettail(src));
4698 	return;
4699     }
4700 
4701     /*
4702      * We check both the value of the $HOME environment variable and the
4703      * "real" home directory.
4704      */
4705     if (homedir != NULL)
4706 	dirlen = STRLEN(homedir);
4707 
4708 #ifdef VMS
4709     homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN");
4710 #else
4711     homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME");
4712 #endif
4713     /* Empty is the same as not set. */
4714     if (homedir_env != NULL && *homedir_env == NUL)
4715 	homedir_env = NULL;
4716 
4717 #if defined(FEAT_MODIFY_FNAME) || defined(FEAT_EVAL)
4718     if (homedir_env != NULL && vim_strchr(homedir_env, '~') != NULL)
4719     {
4720 	int	usedlen = 0;
4721 	int	flen;
4722 	char_u	*fbuf = NULL;
4723 
4724 	flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env);
4725 	(void)modify_fname((char_u *)":p", &usedlen,
4726 						  &homedir_env, &fbuf, &flen);
4727 	flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env);
4728 	if (flen > 0 && vim_ispathsep(homedir_env[flen - 1]))
4729 	    /* Remove the trailing / that is added to a directory. */
4730 	    homedir_env[flen - 1] = NUL;
4731     }
4732 #endif
4733 
4734     if (homedir_env != NULL)
4735 	envlen = STRLEN(homedir_env);
4736 
4737     if (!one)
4738 	src = skipwhite(src);
4739     while (*src && dstlen > 0)
4740     {
4741 	/*
4742 	 * Here we are at the beginning of a file name.
4743 	 * First, check to see if the beginning of the file name matches
4744 	 * $HOME or the "real" home directory. Check that there is a '/'
4745 	 * after the match (so that if e.g. the file is "/home/pieter/bla",
4746 	 * and the home directory is "/home/piet", the file does not end up
4747 	 * as "~er/bla" (which would seem to indicate the file "bla" in user
4748 	 * er's home directory)).
4749 	 */
4750 	p = homedir;
4751 	len = dirlen;
4752 	for (;;)
4753 	{
4754 	    if (   len
4755 		&& fnamencmp(src, p, len) == 0
4756 		&& (vim_ispathsep(src[len])
4757 		    || (!one && (src[len] == ',' || src[len] == ' '))
4758 		    || src[len] == NUL))
4759 	    {
4760 		src += len;
4761 		if (--dstlen > 0)
4762 		    *dst++ = '~';
4763 
4764 		/*
4765 		 * If it's just the home directory, add  "/".
4766 		 */
4767 		if (!vim_ispathsep(src[0]) && --dstlen > 0)
4768 		    *dst++ = '/';
4769 		break;
4770 	    }
4771 	    if (p == homedir_env)
4772 		break;
4773 	    p = homedir_env;
4774 	    len = envlen;
4775 	}
4776 
4777 	/* if (!one) skip to separator: space or comma */
4778 	while (*src && (one || (*src != ',' && *src != ' ')) && --dstlen > 0)
4779 	    *dst++ = *src++;
4780 	/* skip separator */
4781 	while ((*src == ' ' || *src == ',') && --dstlen > 0)
4782 	    *dst++ = *src++;
4783     }
4784     /* if (dstlen == 0) out of space, what to do??? */
4785 
4786     *dst = NUL;
4787 
4788     if (homedir_env != homedir_env_orig)
4789 	vim_free(homedir_env);
4790 }
4791 
4792 /*
4793  * Like home_replace, store the replaced string in allocated memory.
4794  * When something fails, NULL is returned.
4795  */
4796     char_u  *
4797 home_replace_save(buf, src)
4798     buf_T	*buf;	/* when not NULL, check for help files */
4799     char_u	*src;	/* input file name */
4800 {
4801     char_u	*dst;
4802     unsigned	len;
4803 
4804     len = 3;			/* space for "~/" and trailing NUL */
4805     if (src != NULL)		/* just in case */
4806 	len += (unsigned)STRLEN(src);
4807     dst = alloc(len);
4808     if (dst != NULL)
4809 	home_replace(buf, src, dst, len, TRUE);
4810     return dst;
4811 }
4812 
4813 /*
4814  * Compare two file names and return:
4815  * FPC_SAME   if they both exist and are the same file.
4816  * FPC_SAMEX  if they both don't exist and have the same file name.
4817  * FPC_DIFF   if they both exist and are different files.
4818  * FPC_NOTX   if they both don't exist.
4819  * FPC_DIFFX  if one of them doesn't exist.
4820  * For the first name environment variables are expanded
4821  */
4822     int
4823 fullpathcmp(s1, s2, checkname)
4824     char_u *s1, *s2;
4825     int	    checkname;		/* when both don't exist, check file names */
4826 {
4827 #ifdef UNIX
4828     char_u	    exp1[MAXPATHL];
4829     char_u	    full1[MAXPATHL];
4830     char_u	    full2[MAXPATHL];
4831     struct stat	    st1, st2;
4832     int		    r1, r2;
4833 
4834     expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL);
4835     r1 = mch_stat((char *)exp1, &st1);
4836     r2 = mch_stat((char *)s2, &st2);
4837     if (r1 != 0 && r2 != 0)
4838     {
4839 	/* if mch_stat() doesn't work, may compare the names */
4840 	if (checkname)
4841 	{
4842 	    if (fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0)
4843 		return FPC_SAMEX;
4844 	    r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE);
4845 	    r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE);
4846 	    if (r1 == OK && r2 == OK && fnamecmp(full1, full2) == 0)
4847 		return FPC_SAMEX;
4848 	}
4849 	return FPC_NOTX;
4850     }
4851     if (r1 != 0 || r2 != 0)
4852 	return FPC_DIFFX;
4853     if (st1.st_dev == st2.st_dev && st1.st_ino == st2.st_ino)
4854 	return FPC_SAME;
4855     return FPC_DIFF;
4856 #else
4857     char_u  *exp1;		/* expanded s1 */
4858     char_u  *full1;		/* full path of s1 */
4859     char_u  *full2;		/* full path of s2 */
4860     int	    retval = FPC_DIFF;
4861     int	    r1, r2;
4862 
4863     /* allocate one buffer to store three paths (alloc()/free() is slow!) */
4864     if ((exp1 = alloc(MAXPATHL * 3)) != NULL)
4865     {
4866 	full1 = exp1 + MAXPATHL;
4867 	full2 = full1 + MAXPATHL;
4868 
4869 	expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL);
4870 	r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE);
4871 	r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE);
4872 
4873 	/* If vim_FullName() fails, the file probably doesn't exist. */
4874 	if (r1 != OK && r2 != OK)
4875 	{
4876 	    if (checkname && fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0)
4877 		retval = FPC_SAMEX;
4878 	    else
4879 		retval = FPC_NOTX;
4880 	}
4881 	else if (r1 != OK || r2 != OK)
4882 	    retval = FPC_DIFFX;
4883 	else if (fnamecmp(full1, full2))
4884 	    retval = FPC_DIFF;
4885 	else
4886 	    retval = FPC_SAME;
4887 	vim_free(exp1);
4888     }
4889     return retval;
4890 #endif
4891 }
4892 
4893 /*
4894  * Get the tail of a path: the file name.
4895  * When the path ends in a path separator the tail is the NUL after it.
4896  * Fail safe: never returns NULL.
4897  */
4898     char_u *
4899 gettail(fname)
4900     char_u *fname;
4901 {
4902     char_u  *p1, *p2;
4903 
4904     if (fname == NULL)
4905 	return (char_u *)"";
4906     for (p1 = p2 = get_past_head(fname); *p2; )	/* find last part of path */
4907     {
4908 	if (vim_ispathsep_nocolon(*p2))
4909 	    p1 = p2 + 1;
4910 	mb_ptr_adv(p2);
4911     }
4912     return p1;
4913 }
4914 
4915 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH)
4916 static char_u *gettail_dir __ARGS((char_u *fname));
4917 
4918 /*
4919  * Return the end of the directory name, on the first path
4920  * separator:
4921  * "/path/file", "/path/dir/", "/path//dir", "/file"
4922  *	 ^	       ^	     ^	      ^
4923  */
4924     static char_u *
4925 gettail_dir(fname)
4926     char_u *fname;
4927 {
4928     char_u	*dir_end = fname;
4929     char_u	*next_dir_end = fname;
4930     int		look_for_sep = TRUE;
4931     char_u	*p;
4932 
4933     for (p = fname; *p != NUL; )
4934     {
4935 	if (vim_ispathsep(*p))
4936 	{
4937 	    if (look_for_sep)
4938 	    {
4939 		next_dir_end = p;
4940 		look_for_sep = FALSE;
4941 	    }
4942 	}
4943 	else
4944 	{
4945 	    if (!look_for_sep)
4946 		dir_end = next_dir_end;
4947 	    look_for_sep = TRUE;
4948 	}
4949 	mb_ptr_adv(p);
4950     }
4951     return dir_end;
4952 }
4953 #endif
4954 
4955 /*
4956  * Get pointer to tail of "fname", including path separators.  Putting a NUL
4957  * here leaves the directory name.  Takes care of "c:/" and "//".
4958  * Always returns a valid pointer.
4959  */
4960     char_u *
4961 gettail_sep(fname)
4962     char_u	*fname;
4963 {
4964     char_u	*p;
4965     char_u	*t;
4966 
4967     p = get_past_head(fname);	/* don't remove the '/' from "c:/file" */
4968     t = gettail(fname);
4969     while (t > p && after_pathsep(fname, t))
4970 	--t;
4971 #ifdef VMS
4972     /* path separator is part of the path */
4973     ++t;
4974 #endif
4975     return t;
4976 }
4977 
4978 /*
4979  * get the next path component (just after the next path separator).
4980  */
4981     char_u *
4982 getnextcomp(fname)
4983     char_u *fname;
4984 {
4985     while (*fname && !vim_ispathsep(*fname))
4986 	mb_ptr_adv(fname);
4987     if (*fname)
4988 	++fname;
4989     return fname;
4990 }
4991 
4992 /*
4993  * Get a pointer to one character past the head of a path name.
4994  * Unix: after "/"; DOS: after "c:\"; Amiga: after "disk:/"; Mac: no head.
4995  * If there is no head, path is returned.
4996  */
4997     char_u *
4998 get_past_head(path)
4999     char_u  *path;
5000 {
5001     char_u  *retval;
5002 
5003 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2)
5004     /* may skip "c:" */
5005     if (isalpha(path[0]) && path[1] == ':')
5006 	retval = path + 2;
5007     else
5008 	retval = path;
5009 #else
5010 # if defined(AMIGA)
5011     /* may skip "label:" */
5012     retval = vim_strchr(path, ':');
5013     if (retval == NULL)
5014 	retval = path;
5015 # else	/* Unix */
5016     retval = path;
5017 # endif
5018 #endif
5019 
5020     while (vim_ispathsep(*retval))
5021 	++retval;
5022 
5023     return retval;
5024 }
5025 
5026 /*
5027  * Return TRUE if 'c' is a path separator.
5028  * Note that for MS-Windows this includes the colon.
5029  */
5030     int
5031 vim_ispathsep(c)
5032     int c;
5033 {
5034 #ifdef UNIX
5035     return (c == '/');	    /* UNIX has ':' inside file names */
5036 #else
5037 # ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
5038     return (c == ':' || c == '/' || c == '\\');
5039 # else
5040 #  ifdef VMS
5041     /* server"user passwd"::device:[full.path.name]fname.extension;version" */
5042     return (c == ':' || c == '[' || c == ']' || c == '/'
5043 	    || c == '<' || c == '>' || c == '"' );
5044 #  else
5045     return (c == ':' || c == '/');
5046 #  endif /* VMS */
5047 # endif
5048 #endif
5049 }
5050 
5051 /*
5052  * Like vim_ispathsep(c), but exclude the colon for MS-Windows.
5053  */
5054     int
5055 vim_ispathsep_nocolon(c)
5056     int c;
5057 {
5058     return vim_ispathsep(c)
5059 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
5060 	&& c != ':'
5061 #endif
5062 	;
5063 }
5064 
5065 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(PROTO)
5066 /*
5067  * return TRUE if 'c' is a path list separator.
5068  */
5069     int
5070 vim_ispathlistsep(c)
5071     int c;
5072 {
5073 #ifdef UNIX
5074     return (c == ':');
5075 #else
5076     return (c == ';');	/* might not be right for every system... */
5077 #endif
5078 }
5079 #endif
5080 
5081 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_TABLINE) || defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) \
5082 	|| defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
5083 /*
5084  * Shorten the path of a file from "~/foo/../.bar/fname" to "~/f/../.b/fname"
5085  * It's done in-place.
5086  */
5087     void
5088 shorten_dir(str)
5089     char_u *str;
5090 {
5091     char_u	*tail, *s, *d;
5092     int		skip = FALSE;
5093 
5094     tail = gettail(str);
5095     d = str;
5096     for (s = str; ; ++s)
5097     {
5098 	if (s >= tail)		    /* copy the whole tail */
5099 	{
5100 	    *d++ = *s;
5101 	    if (*s == NUL)
5102 		break;
5103 	}
5104 	else if (vim_ispathsep(*s))	    /* copy '/' and next char */
5105 	{
5106 	    *d++ = *s;
5107 	    skip = FALSE;
5108 	}
5109 	else if (!skip)
5110 	{
5111 	    *d++ = *s;		    /* copy next char */
5112 	    if (*s != '~' && *s != '.') /* and leading "~" and "." */
5113 		skip = TRUE;
5114 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
5115 	    if (has_mbyte)
5116 	    {
5117 		int l = mb_ptr2len(s);
5118 
5119 		while (--l > 0)
5120 		    *d++ = *++s;
5121 	    }
5122 # endif
5123 	}
5124     }
5125 }
5126 #endif
5127 
5128 /*
5129  * Return TRUE if the directory of "fname" exists, FALSE otherwise.
5130  * Also returns TRUE if there is no directory name.
5131  * "fname" must be writable!.
5132  */
5133     int
5134 dir_of_file_exists(fname)
5135     char_u	*fname;
5136 {
5137     char_u	*p;
5138     int		c;
5139     int		retval;
5140 
5141     p = gettail_sep(fname);
5142     if (p == fname)
5143 	return TRUE;
5144     c = *p;
5145     *p = NUL;
5146     retval = mch_isdir(fname);
5147     *p = c;
5148     return retval;
5149 }
5150 
5151 /*
5152  * Versions of fnamecmp() and fnamencmp() that handle '/' and '\' equally
5153  * and deal with 'fileignorecase'.
5154  */
5155     int
5156 vim_fnamecmp(x, y)
5157     char_u	*x, *y;
5158 {
5159 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
5160     return vim_fnamencmp(x, y, MAXPATHL);
5161 #else
5162     if (p_fic)
5163 	return MB_STRICMP(x, y);
5164     return STRCMP(x, y);
5165 #endif
5166 }
5167 
5168     int
5169 vim_fnamencmp(x, y, len)
5170     char_u	*x, *y;
5171     size_t	len;
5172 {
5173 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
5174     char_u	*px = x;
5175     char_u	*py = y;
5176     int		cx = NUL;
5177     int		cy = NUL;
5178 
5179     while (len > 0)
5180     {
5181 	cx = PTR2CHAR(px);
5182 	cy = PTR2CHAR(py);
5183 	if (cx == NUL || cy == NUL
5184 	    || ((p_fic ? MB_TOLOWER(cx) != MB_TOLOWER(cy) : cx != cy)
5185 		&& !(cx == '/' && cy == '\\')
5186 		&& !(cx == '\\' && cy == '/')))
5187 	    break;
5188 	len -= MB_PTR2LEN(px);
5189 	px += MB_PTR2LEN(px);
5190 	py += MB_PTR2LEN(py);
5191     }
5192     if (len == 0)
5193 	return 0;
5194     return (cx - cy);
5195 #else
5196     if (p_fic)
5197 	return MB_STRNICMP(x, y, len);
5198     return STRNCMP(x, y, len);
5199 #endif
5200 }
5201 
5202 /*
5203  * Concatenate file names fname1 and fname2 into allocated memory.
5204  * Only add a '/' or '\\' when 'sep' is TRUE and it is necessary.
5205  */
5206     char_u  *
5207 concat_fnames(fname1, fname2, sep)
5208     char_u  *fname1;
5209     char_u  *fname2;
5210     int	    sep;
5211 {
5212     char_u  *dest;
5213 
5214     dest = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(fname1) + STRLEN(fname2) + 3));
5215     if (dest != NULL)
5216     {
5217 	STRCPY(dest, fname1);
5218 	if (sep)
5219 	    add_pathsep(dest);
5220 	STRCAT(dest, fname2);
5221     }
5222     return dest;
5223 }
5224 
5225 /*
5226  * Concatenate two strings and return the result in allocated memory.
5227  * Returns NULL when out of memory.
5228  */
5229     char_u  *
5230 concat_str(str1, str2)
5231     char_u  *str1;
5232     char_u  *str2;
5233 {
5234     char_u  *dest;
5235     size_t  l = STRLEN(str1);
5236 
5237     dest = alloc((unsigned)(l + STRLEN(str2) + 1L));
5238     if (dest != NULL)
5239     {
5240 	STRCPY(dest, str1);
5241 	STRCPY(dest + l, str2);
5242     }
5243     return dest;
5244 }
5245 
5246 /*
5247  * Add a path separator to a file name, unless it already ends in a path
5248  * separator.
5249  */
5250     void
5251 add_pathsep(p)
5252     char_u	*p;
5253 {
5254     if (*p != NUL && !after_pathsep(p, p + STRLEN(p)))
5255 	STRCAT(p, PATHSEPSTR);
5256 }
5257 
5258 /*
5259  * FullName_save - Make an allocated copy of a full file name.
5260  * Returns NULL when out of memory.
5261  */
5262     char_u  *
5263 FullName_save(fname, force)
5264     char_u	*fname;
5265     int		force;		/* force expansion, even when it already looks
5266 				 * like a full path name */
5267 {
5268     char_u	*buf;
5269     char_u	*new_fname = NULL;
5270 
5271     if (fname == NULL)
5272 	return NULL;
5273 
5274     buf = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL);
5275     if (buf != NULL)
5276     {
5277 	if (vim_FullName(fname, buf, MAXPATHL, force) != FAIL)
5278 	    new_fname = vim_strsave(buf);
5279 	else
5280 	    new_fname = vim_strsave(fname);
5281 	vim_free(buf);
5282     }
5283     return new_fname;
5284 }
5285 
5286 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SYN_HL)
5287 
5288 static char_u	*skip_string __ARGS((char_u *p));
5289 static pos_T *ind_find_start_comment __ARGS((void));
5290 static pos_T *ind_find_start_CORS __ARGS((void));
5291 static pos_T *find_start_rawstring __ARGS((int ind_maxcomment));
5292 
5293 /*
5294  * Find the start of a comment, not knowing if we are in a comment right now.
5295  * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards.
5296  * Return NULL when not inside a comment.
5297  */
5298     static pos_T *
5299 ind_find_start_comment()	    /* XXX */
5300 {
5301     return find_start_comment(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment);
5302 }
5303 
5304     pos_T *
5305 find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)	    /* XXX */
5306     int		ind_maxcomment;
5307 {
5308     pos_T	*pos;
5309     char_u	*line;
5310     char_u	*p;
5311     int		cur_maxcomment = ind_maxcomment;
5312 
5313     for (;;)
5314     {
5315 	pos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '*', FM_BACKWARD, cur_maxcomment);
5316 	if (pos == NULL)
5317 	    break;
5318 
5319 	/*
5320 	 * Check if the comment start we found is inside a string.
5321 	 * If it is then restrict the search to below this line and try again.
5322 	 */
5323 	line = ml_get(pos->lnum);
5324 	for (p = line; *p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < pos->col; ++p)
5325 	    p = skip_string(p);
5326 	if ((colnr_T)(p - line) <= pos->col)
5327 	    break;
5328 	cur_maxcomment = curwin->w_cursor.lnum - pos->lnum - 1;
5329 	if (cur_maxcomment <= 0)
5330 	{
5331 	    pos = NULL;
5332 	    break;
5333 	}
5334     }
5335     return pos;
5336 }
5337 
5338 /*
5339  * Find the start of a comment or raw string, not knowing if we are in a
5340  * comment or raw string right now.
5341  * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards.
5342  * Return NULL when not inside a comment or raw string.
5343  * "CORS" -> Comment Or Raw String
5344  */
5345     static pos_T *
5346 ind_find_start_CORS()	    /* XXX */
5347 {
5348     static pos_T comment_pos_copy;
5349     pos_T	*comment_pos;
5350     pos_T	*rs_pos;
5351 
5352     comment_pos = find_start_comment(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment);
5353     if (comment_pos != NULL)
5354     {
5355 	/* Need to make a copy of the static pos in findmatchlimit(),
5356 	 * calling find_start_rawstring() may change it. */
5357 	comment_pos_copy = *comment_pos;
5358 	comment_pos = &comment_pos_copy;
5359     }
5360     rs_pos = find_start_rawstring(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment);
5361 
5362     /* If comment_pos is before rs_pos the raw string is inside the comment.
5363      * If rs_pos is before comment_pos the comment is inside the raw string. */
5364     if (comment_pos == NULL || (rs_pos != NULL && lt(*rs_pos, *comment_pos)))
5365 	return rs_pos;
5366     return comment_pos;
5367 }
5368 
5369 /*
5370  * Find the start of a raw string, not knowing if we are in one right now.
5371  * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards.
5372  * Return NULL when not inside a raw string.
5373  */
5374     static pos_T *
5375 find_start_rawstring(ind_maxcomment)	    /* XXX */
5376     int		ind_maxcomment;
5377 {
5378     pos_T	*pos;
5379     char_u	*line;
5380     char_u	*p;
5381     int		cur_maxcomment = ind_maxcomment;
5382 
5383     for (;;)
5384     {
5385 	pos = findmatchlimit(NULL, 'R', FM_BACKWARD, cur_maxcomment);
5386 	if (pos == NULL)
5387 	    break;
5388 
5389 	/*
5390 	 * Check if the raw string start we found is inside a string.
5391 	 * If it is then restrict the search to below this line and try again.
5392 	 */
5393 	line = ml_get(pos->lnum);
5394 	for (p = line; *p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < pos->col; ++p)
5395 	    p = skip_string(p);
5396 	if ((colnr_T)(p - line) <= pos->col)
5397 	    break;
5398 	cur_maxcomment = curwin->w_cursor.lnum - pos->lnum - 1;
5399 	if (cur_maxcomment <= 0)
5400 	{
5401 	    pos = NULL;
5402 	    break;
5403 	}
5404     }
5405     return pos;
5406 }
5407 
5408 /*
5409  * Skip to the end of a "string" and a 'c' character.
5410  * If there is no string or character, return argument unmodified.
5411  */
5412     static char_u *
5413 skip_string(p)
5414     char_u  *p;
5415 {
5416     int	    i;
5417 
5418     /*
5419      * We loop, because strings may be concatenated: "date""time".
5420      */
5421     for ( ; ; ++p)
5422     {
5423 	if (p[0] == '\'')		    /* 'c' or '\n' or '\000' */
5424 	{
5425 	    if (!p[1])			    /* ' at end of line */
5426 		break;
5427 	    i = 2;
5428 	    if (p[1] == '\\')		    /* '\n' or '\000' */
5429 	    {
5430 		++i;
5431 		while (vim_isdigit(p[i - 1]))   /* '\000' */
5432 		    ++i;
5433 	    }
5434 	    if (p[i] == '\'')		    /* check for trailing ' */
5435 	    {
5436 		p += i;
5437 		continue;
5438 	    }
5439 	}
5440 	else if (p[0] == '"')		    /* start of string */
5441 	{
5442 	    for (++p; p[0]; ++p)
5443 	    {
5444 		if (p[0] == '\\' && p[1] != NUL)
5445 		    ++p;
5446 		else if (p[0] == '"')	    /* end of string */
5447 		    break;
5448 	    }
5449 	    if (p[0] == '"')
5450 		continue; /* continue for another string */
5451 	}
5452 	else if (p[0] == 'R' && p[1] == '"')
5453 	{
5454 	    /* Raw string: R"[delim](...)[delim]" */
5455 	    char_u *delim = p + 2;
5456 	    char_u *paren = vim_strchr(delim, '(');
5457 
5458 	    if (paren != NULL)
5459 	    {
5460 		size_t delim_len = paren - delim;
5461 
5462 		for (p += 3; *p; ++p)
5463 		    if (p[0] == ')' && STRNCMP(p + 1, delim, delim_len) == 0
5464 			    && p[delim_len + 1] == '"')
5465 		    {
5466 			p += delim_len + 1;
5467 			break;
5468 		    }
5469 		if (p[0] == '"')
5470 		    continue; /* continue for another string */
5471 	    }
5472 	}
5473 	break;				    /* no string found */
5474     }
5475     if (!*p)
5476 	--p;				    /* backup from NUL */
5477     return p;
5478 }
5479 #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT || FEAT_SYN_HL */
5480 
5481 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(PROTO)
5482 
5483 /*
5484  * Do C or expression indenting on the current line.
5485  */
5486     void
5487 do_c_expr_indent()
5488 {
5489 # ifdef FEAT_EVAL
5490     if (*curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL)
5491 	fixthisline(get_expr_indent);
5492     else
5493 # endif
5494 	fixthisline(get_c_indent);
5495 }
5496 
5497 /* Find result cache for cpp_baseclass */
5498 typedef struct {
5499     int	    found;
5500     lpos_T  lpos;
5501 } cpp_baseclass_cache_T;
5502 
5503 /*
5504  * Functions for C-indenting.
5505  * Most of this originally comes from Eric Fischer.
5506  */
5507 /*
5508  * Below "XXX" means that this function may unlock the current line.
5509  */
5510 
5511 static char_u	*cin_skipcomment __ARGS((char_u *));
5512 static int	cin_nocode __ARGS((char_u *));
5513 static pos_T	*find_line_comment __ARGS((void));
5514 static int	cin_has_js_key __ARGS((char_u *text));
5515 static int	cin_islabel_skip __ARGS((char_u **));
5516 static int	cin_isdefault __ARGS((char_u *));
5517 static char_u	*after_label __ARGS((char_u *l));
5518 static int	get_indent_nolabel __ARGS((linenr_T lnum));
5519 static int	skip_label __ARGS((linenr_T, char_u **pp));
5520 static int	cin_first_id_amount __ARGS((void));
5521 static int	cin_get_equal_amount __ARGS((linenr_T lnum));
5522 static int	cin_ispreproc __ARGS((char_u *));
5523 static int	cin_ispreproc_cont __ARGS((char_u **pp, linenr_T *lnump));
5524 static int	cin_iscomment __ARGS((char_u *));
5525 static int	cin_islinecomment __ARGS((char_u *));
5526 static int	cin_isterminated __ARGS((char_u *, int, int));
5527 static int	cin_isinit __ARGS((void));
5528 static int	cin_isfuncdecl __ARGS((char_u **, linenr_T, linenr_T));
5529 static int	cin_isif __ARGS((char_u *));
5530 static int	cin_iselse __ARGS((char_u *));
5531 static int	cin_isdo __ARGS((char_u *));
5532 static int	cin_iswhileofdo __ARGS((char_u *, linenr_T));
5533 static int	cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset __ARGS((char_u *line, int *poffset));
5534 static int	cin_iswhileofdo_end __ARGS((int terminated));
5535 static int	cin_isbreak __ARGS((char_u *));
5536 static int	cin_is_cpp_baseclass __ARGS((cpp_baseclass_cache_T *cached));
5537 static int	get_baseclass_amount __ARGS((int col));
5538 static int	cin_ends_in __ARGS((char_u *, char_u *, char_u *));
5539 static int	cin_starts_with __ARGS((char_u *s, char *word));
5540 static int	cin_skip2pos __ARGS((pos_T *trypos));
5541 static pos_T	*find_start_brace __ARGS((void));
5542 static pos_T	*find_match_paren __ARGS((int));
5543 static pos_T	*find_match_char __ARGS((int c, int ind_maxparen));
5544 static int	corr_ind_maxparen __ARGS((pos_T *startpos));
5545 static int	find_last_paren __ARGS((char_u *l, int start, int end));
5546 static int	find_match __ARGS((int lookfor, linenr_T ourscope));
5547 static int	cin_is_cpp_namespace __ARGS((char_u *));
5548 
5549 /*
5550  * Skip over white space and C comments within the line.
5551  * Also skip over Perl/shell comments if desired.
5552  */
5553     static char_u *
5554 cin_skipcomment(s)
5555     char_u	*s;
5556 {
5557     while (*s)
5558     {
5559 	char_u *prev_s = s;
5560 
5561 	s = skipwhite(s);
5562 
5563 	/* Perl/shell # comment comment continues until eol.  Require a space
5564 	 * before # to avoid recognizing $#array. */
5565 	if (curbuf->b_ind_hash_comment != 0 && s != prev_s && *s == '#')
5566 	{
5567 	    s += STRLEN(s);
5568 	    break;
5569 	}
5570 	if (*s != '/')
5571 	    break;
5572 	++s;
5573 	if (*s == '/')		/* slash-slash comment continues till eol */
5574 	{
5575 	    s += STRLEN(s);
5576 	    break;
5577 	}
5578 	if (*s != '*')
5579 	    break;
5580 	for (++s; *s; ++s)	/* skip slash-star comment */
5581 	    if (s[0] == '*' && s[1] == '/')
5582 	    {
5583 		s += 2;
5584 		break;
5585 	    }
5586     }
5587     return s;
5588 }
5589 
5590 /*
5591  * Return TRUE if there is no code at *s.  White space and comments are
5592  * not considered code.
5593  */
5594     static int
5595 cin_nocode(s)
5596     char_u	*s;
5597 {
5598     return *cin_skipcomment(s) == NUL;
5599 }
5600 
5601 /*
5602  * Check previous lines for a "//" line comment, skipping over blank lines.
5603  */
5604     static pos_T *
5605 find_line_comment() /* XXX */
5606 {
5607     static pos_T pos;
5608     char_u	 *line;
5609     char_u	 *p;
5610 
5611     pos = curwin->w_cursor;
5612     while (--pos.lnum > 0)
5613     {
5614 	line = ml_get(pos.lnum);
5615 	p = skipwhite(line);
5616 	if (cin_islinecomment(p))
5617 	{
5618 	    pos.col = (int)(p - line);
5619 	    return &pos;
5620 	}
5621 	if (*p != NUL)
5622 	    break;
5623     }
5624     return NULL;
5625 }
5626 
5627 /*
5628  * Return TRUE if "text" starts with "key:".
5629  */
5630     static int
5631 cin_has_js_key(text)
5632     char_u *text;
5633 {
5634     char_u *s = skipwhite(text);
5635     int	    quote = -1;
5636 
5637     if (*s == '\'' || *s == '"')
5638     {
5639 	/* can be 'key': or "key": */
5640 	quote = *s;
5641 	++s;
5642     }
5643     if (!vim_isIDc(*s))	    /* need at least one ID character */
5644 	return FALSE;
5645 
5646     while (vim_isIDc(*s))
5647 	++s;
5648     if (*s == quote)
5649 	++s;
5650 
5651     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
5652 
5653     /* "::" is not a label, it's C++ */
5654     return (*s == ':' && s[1] != ':');
5655 }
5656 
5657 /*
5658  * Check if string matches "label:"; move to character after ':' if true.
5659  * "*s" must point to the start of the label, if there is one.
5660  */
5661     static int
5662 cin_islabel_skip(s)
5663     char_u	**s;
5664 {
5665     if (!vim_isIDc(**s))	    /* need at least one ID character */
5666 	return FALSE;
5667 
5668     while (vim_isIDc(**s))
5669 	(*s)++;
5670 
5671     *s = cin_skipcomment(*s);
5672 
5673     /* "::" is not a label, it's C++ */
5674     return (**s == ':' && *++*s != ':');
5675 }
5676 
5677 /*
5678  * Recognize a label: "label:".
5679  * Note: curwin->w_cursor must be where we are looking for the label.
5680  */
5681     int
5682 cin_islabel()		/* XXX */
5683 {
5684     char_u	*s;
5685 
5686     s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
5687 
5688     /*
5689      * Exclude "default" from labels, since it should be indented
5690      * like a switch label.  Same for C++ scope declarations.
5691      */
5692     if (cin_isdefault(s))
5693 	return FALSE;
5694     if (cin_isscopedecl(s))
5695 	return FALSE;
5696 
5697     if (cin_islabel_skip(&s))
5698     {
5699 	/*
5700 	 * Only accept a label if the previous line is terminated or is a case
5701 	 * label.
5702 	 */
5703 	pos_T	cursor_save;
5704 	pos_T	*trypos;
5705 	char_u	*line;
5706 
5707 	cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
5708 	while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
5709 	{
5710 	    --curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
5711 
5712 	    /*
5713 	     * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start of
5714 	     * it.
5715 	     */
5716 	    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
5717 	    if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) /* XXX */
5718 		curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
5719 
5720 	    line = ml_get_curline();
5721 	    if (cin_ispreproc(line))	/* ignore #defines, #if, etc. */
5722 		continue;
5723 	    if (*(line = cin_skipcomment(line)) == NUL)
5724 		continue;
5725 
5726 	    curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
5727 	    if (cin_isterminated(line, TRUE, FALSE)
5728 		    || cin_isscopedecl(line)
5729 		    || cin_iscase(line, TRUE)
5730 		    || (cin_islabel_skip(&line) && cin_nocode(line)))
5731 		return TRUE;
5732 	    return FALSE;
5733 	}
5734 	curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
5735 	return TRUE;		/* label at start of file??? */
5736     }
5737     return FALSE;
5738 }
5739 
5740 /*
5741  * Recognize structure initialization and enumerations:
5742  * "[typedef] [static|public|protected|private] enum"
5743  * "[typedef] [static|public|protected|private] = {"
5744  */
5745     static int
5746 cin_isinit(void)
5747 {
5748     char_u	*s;
5749     static char *skip[] = {"static", "public", "protected", "private"};
5750 
5751     s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
5752 
5753     if (cin_starts_with(s, "typedef"))
5754 	s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7);
5755 
5756     for (;;)
5757     {
5758 	int i, l;
5759 
5760 	for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(skip) / sizeof(char *)); ++i)
5761 	{
5762 	    l = (int)strlen(skip[i]);
5763 	    if (cin_starts_with(s, skip[i]))
5764 	    {
5765 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + l);
5766 		l = 0;
5767 		break;
5768 	    }
5769 	}
5770 	if (l != 0)
5771 	    break;
5772     }
5773 
5774     if (cin_starts_with(s, "enum"))
5775 	return TRUE;
5776 
5777     if (cin_ends_in(s, (char_u *)"=", (char_u *)"{"))
5778 	return TRUE;
5779 
5780     return FALSE;
5781 }
5782 
5783 /*
5784  * Recognize a switch label: "case .*:" or "default:".
5785  */
5786      int
5787 cin_iscase(s, strict)
5788     char_u *s;
5789     int strict; /* Allow relaxed check of case statement for JS */
5790 {
5791     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
5792     if (cin_starts_with(s, "case"))
5793     {
5794 	for (s += 4; *s; ++s)
5795 	{
5796 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s);
5797 	    if (*s == ':')
5798 	    {
5799 		if (s[1] == ':')	/* skip over "::" for C++ */
5800 		    ++s;
5801 		else
5802 		    return TRUE;
5803 	    }
5804 	    if (*s == '\'' && s[1] && s[2] == '\'')
5805 		s += 2;			/* skip over ':' */
5806 	    else if (*s == '/' && (s[1] == '*' || s[1] == '/'))
5807 		return FALSE;		/* stop at comment */
5808 	    else if (*s == '"')
5809 	    {
5810 		/* JS etc. */
5811 		if (strict)
5812 		    return FALSE;		/* stop at string */
5813 		else
5814 		    return TRUE;
5815 	    }
5816 	}
5817 	return FALSE;
5818     }
5819 
5820     if (cin_isdefault(s))
5821 	return TRUE;
5822     return FALSE;
5823 }
5824 
5825 /*
5826  * Recognize a "default" switch label.
5827  */
5828     static int
5829 cin_isdefault(s)
5830     char_u  *s;
5831 {
5832     return (STRNCMP(s, "default", 7) == 0
5833 	    && *(s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7)) == ':'
5834 	    && s[1] != ':');
5835 }
5836 
5837 /*
5838  * Recognize a "public/private/protected" scope declaration label.
5839  */
5840     int
5841 cin_isscopedecl(s)
5842     char_u	*s;
5843 {
5844     int		i;
5845 
5846     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
5847     if (STRNCMP(s, "public", 6) == 0)
5848 	i = 6;
5849     else if (STRNCMP(s, "protected", 9) == 0)
5850 	i = 9;
5851     else if (STRNCMP(s, "private", 7) == 0)
5852 	i = 7;
5853     else
5854 	return FALSE;
5855     return (*(s = cin_skipcomment(s + i)) == ':' && s[1] != ':');
5856 }
5857 
5858 /* Maximum number of lines to search back for a "namespace" line. */
5859 #define FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM 20
5860 
5861 /*
5862  * Recognize a "namespace" scope declaration.
5863  */
5864     static int
5865 cin_is_cpp_namespace(s)
5866     char_u	*s;
5867 {
5868     char_u	*p;
5869     int		has_name = FALSE;
5870 
5871     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
5872     if (STRNCMP(s, "namespace", 9) == 0 && (s[9] == NUL || !vim_iswordc(s[9])))
5873     {
5874 	p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(s + 9));
5875 	while (*p != NUL)
5876 	{
5877 	    if (vim_iswhite(*p))
5878 	    {
5879 		has_name = TRUE; /* found end of a name */
5880 		p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(p));
5881 	    }
5882 	    else if (*p == '{')
5883 	    {
5884 		break;
5885 	    }
5886 	    else if (vim_iswordc(*p))
5887 	    {
5888 		if (has_name)
5889 		    return FALSE; /* word character after skipping past name */
5890 		++p;
5891 	    }
5892 	    else
5893 	    {
5894 		return FALSE;
5895 	    }
5896 	}
5897 	return TRUE;
5898     }
5899     return FALSE;
5900 }
5901 
5902 /*
5903  * Return a pointer to the first non-empty non-comment character after a ':'.
5904  * Return NULL if not found.
5905  *	  case 234:    a = b;
5906  *		       ^
5907  */
5908     static char_u *
5909 after_label(l)
5910     char_u  *l;
5911 {
5912     for ( ; *l; ++l)
5913     {
5914 	if (*l == ':')
5915 	{
5916 	    if (l[1] == ':')	    /* skip over "::" for C++ */
5917 		++l;
5918 	    else if (!cin_iscase(l + 1, FALSE))
5919 		break;
5920 	}
5921 	else if (*l == '\'' && l[1] && l[2] == '\'')
5922 	    l += 2;		    /* skip over 'x' */
5923     }
5924     if (*l == NUL)
5925 	return NULL;
5926     l = cin_skipcomment(l + 1);
5927     if (*l == NUL)
5928 	return NULL;
5929     return l;
5930 }
5931 
5932 /*
5933  * Get indent of line "lnum", skipping a label.
5934  * Return 0 if there is nothing after the label.
5935  */
5936     static int
5937 get_indent_nolabel(lnum)		/* XXX */
5938     linenr_T	lnum;
5939 {
5940     char_u	*l;
5941     pos_T	fp;
5942     colnr_T	col;
5943     char_u	*p;
5944 
5945     l = ml_get(lnum);
5946     p = after_label(l);
5947     if (p == NULL)
5948 	return 0;
5949 
5950     fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - l);
5951     fp.lnum = lnum;
5952     getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL);
5953     return (int)col;
5954 }
5955 
5956 /*
5957  * Find indent for line "lnum", ignoring any case or jump label.
5958  * Also return a pointer to the text (after the label) in "pp".
5959  *   label:	if (asdf && asdfasdf)
5960  *		^
5961  */
5962     static int
5963 skip_label(lnum, pp)
5964     linenr_T	lnum;
5965     char_u	**pp;
5966 {
5967     char_u	*l;
5968     int		amount;
5969     pos_T	cursor_save;
5970 
5971     cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
5972     curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum;
5973     l = ml_get_curline();
5974 				    /* XXX */
5975     if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l) || cin_islabel())
5976     {
5977 	amount = get_indent_nolabel(lnum);
5978 	l = after_label(ml_get_curline());
5979 	if (l == NULL)		/* just in case */
5980 	    l = ml_get_curline();
5981     }
5982     else
5983     {
5984 	amount = get_indent();
5985 	l = ml_get_curline();
5986     }
5987     *pp = l;
5988 
5989     curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
5990     return amount;
5991 }
5992 
5993 /*
5994  * Return the indent of the first variable name after a type in a declaration.
5995  *  int	    a,			indent of "a"
5996  *  static struct foo    b,	indent of "b"
5997  *  enum bla    c,		indent of "c"
5998  * Returns zero when it doesn't look like a declaration.
5999  */
6000     static int
6001 cin_first_id_amount()
6002 {
6003     char_u	*line, *p, *s;
6004     int		len;
6005     pos_T	fp;
6006     colnr_T	col;
6007 
6008     line = ml_get_curline();
6009     p = skipwhite(line);
6010     len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p);
6011     if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "static", 6) == 0)
6012     {
6013 	p = skipwhite(p + 6);
6014 	len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p);
6015     }
6016     if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "struct", 6) == 0)
6017 	p = skipwhite(p + 6);
6018     else if (len == 4 && STRNCMP(p, "enum", 4) == 0)
6019 	p = skipwhite(p + 4);
6020     else if ((len == 8 && STRNCMP(p, "unsigned", 8) == 0)
6021 	    || (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "signed", 6) == 0))
6022     {
6023 	s = skipwhite(p + len);
6024 	if ((STRNCMP(s, "int", 3) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[3]))
6025 		|| (STRNCMP(s, "long", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4]))
6026 		|| (STRNCMP(s, "short", 5) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[5]))
6027 		|| (STRNCMP(s, "char", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4])))
6028 	    p = s;
6029     }
6030     for (len = 0; vim_isIDc(p[len]); ++len)
6031 	;
6032     if (len == 0 || !vim_iswhite(p[len]) || cin_nocode(p))
6033 	return 0;
6034 
6035     p = skipwhite(p + len);
6036     fp.lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
6037     fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - line);
6038     getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL);
6039     return (int)col;
6040 }
6041 
6042 /*
6043  * Return the indent of the first non-blank after an equal sign.
6044  *       char *foo = "here";
6045  * Return zero if no (useful) equal sign found.
6046  * Return -1 if the line above "lnum" ends in a backslash.
6047  *      foo = "asdf\
6048  *	       asdf\
6049  *	       here";
6050  */
6051     static int
6052 cin_get_equal_amount(lnum)
6053     linenr_T	lnum;
6054 {
6055     char_u	*line;
6056     char_u	*s;
6057     colnr_T	col;
6058     pos_T	fp;
6059 
6060     if (lnum > 1)
6061     {
6062 	line = ml_get(lnum - 1);
6063 	if (*line != NUL && line[STRLEN(line) - 1] == '\\')
6064 	    return -1;
6065     }
6066 
6067     line = s = ml_get(lnum);
6068     while (*s != NUL && vim_strchr((char_u *)"=;{}\"'", *s) == NULL)
6069     {
6070 	if (cin_iscomment(s))	/* ignore comments */
6071 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6072 	else
6073 	    ++s;
6074     }
6075     if (*s != '=')
6076 	return 0;
6077 
6078     s = skipwhite(s + 1);
6079     if (cin_nocode(s))
6080 	return 0;
6081 
6082     if (*s == '"')	/* nice alignment for continued strings */
6083 	++s;
6084 
6085     fp.lnum = lnum;
6086     fp.col = (colnr_T)(s - line);
6087     getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL);
6088     return (int)col;
6089 }
6090 
6091 /*
6092  * Recognize a preprocessor statement: Any line that starts with '#'.
6093  */
6094     static int
6095 cin_ispreproc(s)
6096     char_u *s;
6097 {
6098     if (*skipwhite(s) == '#')
6099 	return TRUE;
6100     return FALSE;
6101 }
6102 
6103 /*
6104  * Return TRUE if line "*pp" at "*lnump" is a preprocessor statement or a
6105  * continuation line of a preprocessor statement.  Decrease "*lnump" to the
6106  * start and return the line in "*pp".
6107  */
6108     static int
6109 cin_ispreproc_cont(pp, lnump)
6110     char_u	**pp;
6111     linenr_T	*lnump;
6112 {
6113     char_u	*line = *pp;
6114     linenr_T	lnum = *lnump;
6115     int		retval = FALSE;
6116 
6117     for (;;)
6118     {
6119 	if (cin_ispreproc(line))
6120 	{
6121 	    retval = TRUE;
6122 	    *lnump = lnum;
6123 	    break;
6124 	}
6125 	if (lnum == 1)
6126 	    break;
6127 	line = ml_get(--lnum);
6128 	if (*line == NUL || line[STRLEN(line) - 1] != '\\')
6129 	    break;
6130     }
6131 
6132     if (lnum != *lnump)
6133 	*pp = ml_get(*lnump);
6134     return retval;
6135 }
6136 
6137 /*
6138  * Recognize the start of a C or C++ comment.
6139  */
6140     static int
6141 cin_iscomment(p)
6142     char_u  *p;
6143 {
6144     return (p[0] == '/' && (p[1] == '*' || p[1] == '/'));
6145 }
6146 
6147 /*
6148  * Recognize the start of a "//" comment.
6149  */
6150     static int
6151 cin_islinecomment(p)
6152     char_u *p;
6153 {
6154     return (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '/');
6155 }
6156 
6157 /*
6158  * Recognize a line that starts with '{' or '}', or ends with ';', ',', '{' or
6159  * '}'.
6160  * Don't consider "} else" a terminated line.
6161  * If a line begins with an "else", only consider it terminated if no unmatched
6162  * opening braces follow (handle "else { foo();" correctly).
6163  * Return the character terminating the line (ending char's have precedence if
6164  * both apply in order to determine initializations).
6165  */
6166     static int
6167 cin_isterminated(s, incl_open, incl_comma)
6168     char_u	*s;
6169     int		incl_open;	/* include '{' at the end as terminator */
6170     int		incl_comma;	/* recognize a trailing comma */
6171 {
6172     char_u	found_start = 0;
6173     unsigned	n_open = 0;
6174     int		is_else = FALSE;
6175 
6176     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6177 
6178     if (*s == '{' || (*s == '}' && !cin_iselse(s)))
6179 	found_start = *s;
6180 
6181     if (!found_start)
6182 	is_else = cin_iselse(s);
6183 
6184     while (*s)
6185     {
6186 	/* skip over comments, "" strings and 'c'haracters */
6187 	s = skip_string(cin_skipcomment(s));
6188 	if (*s == '}' && n_open > 0)
6189 	    --n_open;
6190 	if ((!is_else || n_open == 0)
6191 		&& (*s == ';' || *s == '}' || (incl_comma && *s == ','))
6192 		&& cin_nocode(s + 1))
6193 	    return *s;
6194 	else if (*s == '{')
6195 	{
6196 	    if (incl_open && cin_nocode(s + 1))
6197 		return *s;
6198 	    else
6199 		++n_open;
6200 	}
6201 
6202 	if (*s)
6203 	    s++;
6204     }
6205     return found_start;
6206 }
6207 
6208 /*
6209  * Recognize the basic picture of a function declaration -- it needs to
6210  * have an open paren somewhere and a close paren at the end of the line and
6211  * no semicolons anywhere.
6212  * When a line ends in a comma we continue looking in the next line.
6213  * "sp" points to a string with the line.  When looking at other lines it must
6214  * be restored to the line.  When it's NULL fetch lines here.
6215  * "lnum" is where we start looking.
6216  * "min_lnum" is the line before which we will not be looking.
6217  */
6218     static int
6219 cin_isfuncdecl(sp, first_lnum, min_lnum)
6220     char_u	**sp;
6221     linenr_T	first_lnum;
6222     linenr_T	min_lnum;
6223 {
6224     char_u	*s;
6225     linenr_T	lnum = first_lnum;
6226     int		retval = FALSE;
6227     pos_T	*trypos;
6228     int		just_started = TRUE;
6229 
6230     if (sp == NULL)
6231 	s = ml_get(lnum);
6232     else
6233 	s = *sp;
6234 
6235     if (find_last_paren(s, '(', ')')
6236 	&& (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
6237     {
6238 	lnum = trypos->lnum;
6239 	if (lnum < min_lnum)
6240 	    return FALSE;
6241 
6242 	s = ml_get(lnum);
6243     }
6244 
6245     /* Ignore line starting with #. */
6246     if (cin_ispreproc(s))
6247 	return FALSE;
6248 
6249     while (*s && *s != '(' && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"')
6250     {
6251 	if (cin_iscomment(s))	/* ignore comments */
6252 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6253 	else if (*s == ':')
6254 	{
6255 	    if (*(s + 1) == ':')
6256 		s += 2;
6257 	    else
6258 		/* To avoid a mistake in the following situation:
6259 		 * A::A(int a, int b)
6260 		 *     : a(0)  // <--not a function decl
6261 		 *     , b(0)
6262 		 * {...
6263 		 */
6264 		return FALSE;
6265 	}
6266 	else
6267 	    ++s;
6268     }
6269     if (*s != '(')
6270 	return FALSE;		/* ';', ' or "  before any () or no '(' */
6271 
6272     while (*s && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"')
6273     {
6274 	if (*s == ')' && cin_nocode(s + 1))
6275 	{
6276 	    /* ')' at the end: may have found a match
6277 	     * Check for he previous line not to end in a backslash:
6278 	     *       #if defined(x) && \
6279 	     *		 defined(y)
6280 	     */
6281 	    lnum = first_lnum - 1;
6282 	    s = ml_get(lnum);
6283 	    if (*s == NUL || s[STRLEN(s) - 1] != '\\')
6284 		retval = TRUE;
6285 	    goto done;
6286 	}
6287 	if ((*s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) || s[1] == NUL || cin_nocode(s))
6288 	{
6289 	    int comma = (*s == ',');
6290 
6291 	    /* ',' at the end: continue looking in the next line.
6292 	     * At the end: check for ',' in the next line, for this style:
6293 	     * func(arg1
6294 	     *       , arg2) */
6295 	    for (;;)
6296 	    {
6297 		if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
6298 		    break;
6299 		s = ml_get(++lnum);
6300 		if (!cin_ispreproc(s))
6301 		    break;
6302 	    }
6303 	    if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
6304 		break;
6305 	    /* Require a comma at end of the line or a comma or ')' at the
6306 	     * start of next line. */
6307 	    s = skipwhite(s);
6308 	    if (!just_started && (!comma && *s != ',' && *s != ')'))
6309 		break;
6310 	    just_started = FALSE;
6311 	}
6312 	else if (cin_iscomment(s))	/* ignore comments */
6313 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6314 	else
6315 	{
6316 	    ++s;
6317 	    just_started = FALSE;
6318 	}
6319     }
6320 
6321 done:
6322     if (lnum != first_lnum && sp != NULL)
6323 	*sp = ml_get(first_lnum);
6324 
6325     return retval;
6326 }
6327 
6328     static int
6329 cin_isif(p)
6330     char_u  *p;
6331 {
6332     return (STRNCMP(p, "if", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2]));
6333 }
6334 
6335     static int
6336 cin_iselse(p)
6337     char_u  *p;
6338 {
6339     if (*p == '}')	    /* accept "} else" */
6340 	p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1);
6341     return (STRNCMP(p, "else", 4) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[4]));
6342 }
6343 
6344     static int
6345 cin_isdo(p)
6346     char_u  *p;
6347 {
6348     return (STRNCMP(p, "do", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2]));
6349 }
6350 
6351 /*
6352  * Check if this is a "while" that should have a matching "do".
6353  * We only accept a "while (condition) ;", with only white space between the
6354  * ')' and ';'. The condition may be spread over several lines.
6355  */
6356     static int
6357 cin_iswhileofdo(p, lnum)	    /* XXX */
6358     char_u	*p;
6359     linenr_T	lnum;
6360 {
6361     pos_T	cursor_save;
6362     pos_T	*trypos;
6363     int		retval = FALSE;
6364 
6365     p = cin_skipcomment(p);
6366     if (*p == '}')		/* accept "} while (cond);" */
6367 	p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1);
6368     if (cin_starts_with(p, "while"))
6369     {
6370 	cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
6371 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum;
6372 	curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
6373 	p = ml_get_curline();
6374 	while (*p && *p != 'w')	/* skip any '}', until the 'w' of the "while" */
6375 	{
6376 	    ++p;
6377 	    ++curwin->w_cursor.col;
6378 	}
6379 	if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, 0, 0,
6380 					      curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL
6381 		&& *cin_skipcomment(ml_get_pos(trypos) + 1) == ';')
6382 	    retval = TRUE;
6383 	curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
6384     }
6385     return retval;
6386 }
6387 
6388 /*
6389  * Check whether in "p" there is an "if", "for" or "while" before "*poffset".
6390  * Return 0 if there is none.
6391  * Otherwise return !0 and update "*poffset" to point to the place where the
6392  * string was found.
6393  */
6394     static int
6395 cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, poffset)
6396     char_u *line;
6397     int    *poffset;
6398 {
6399     int offset = *poffset;
6400 
6401     if (offset-- < 2)
6402 	return 0;
6403     while (offset > 2 && vim_iswhite(line[offset]))
6404 	--offset;
6405 
6406     offset -= 1;
6407     if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "if", 2))
6408 	goto probablyFound;
6409 
6410     if (offset >= 1)
6411     {
6412 	offset -= 1;
6413 	if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "for", 3))
6414 	    goto probablyFound;
6415 
6416 	if (offset >= 2)
6417 	{
6418 	    offset -= 2;
6419 	    if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "while", 5))
6420 		goto probablyFound;
6421 	}
6422     }
6423     return 0;
6424 
6425 probablyFound:
6426     if (!offset || !vim_isIDc(line[offset - 1]))
6427     {
6428 	*poffset = offset;
6429 	return 1;
6430     }
6431     return 0;
6432 }
6433 
6434 /*
6435  * Return TRUE if we are at the end of a do-while.
6436  *    do
6437  *       nothing;
6438  *    while (foo
6439  *	       && bar);  <-- here
6440  * Adjust the cursor to the line with "while".
6441  */
6442     static int
6443 cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated)
6444     int	    terminated;
6445 {
6446     char_u	*line;
6447     char_u	*p;
6448     char_u	*s;
6449     pos_T	*trypos;
6450     int		i;
6451 
6452     if (terminated != ';')	/* there must be a ';' at the end */
6453 	return FALSE;
6454 
6455     p = line = ml_get_curline();
6456     while (*p != NUL)
6457     {
6458 	p = cin_skipcomment(p);
6459 	if (*p == ')')
6460 	{
6461 	    s = skipwhite(p + 1);
6462 	    if (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1))
6463 	    {
6464 		/* Found ");" at end of the line, now check there is "while"
6465 		 * before the matching '('.  XXX */
6466 		i = (int)(p - line);
6467 		curwin->w_cursor.col = i;
6468 		trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen);
6469 		if (trypos != NULL)
6470 		{
6471 		    s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get(trypos->lnum));
6472 		    if (*s == '}')		/* accept "} while (cond);" */
6473 			s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1);
6474 		    if (cin_starts_with(s, "while"))
6475 		    {
6476 			curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum;
6477 			return TRUE;
6478 		    }
6479 		}
6480 
6481 		/* Searching may have made "line" invalid, get it again. */
6482 		line = ml_get_curline();
6483 		p = line + i;
6484 	    }
6485 	}
6486 	if (*p != NUL)
6487 	    ++p;
6488     }
6489     return FALSE;
6490 }
6491 
6492     static int
6493 cin_isbreak(p)
6494     char_u  *p;
6495 {
6496     return (STRNCMP(p, "break", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[5]));
6497 }
6498 
6499 /*
6500  * Find the position of a C++ base-class declaration or
6501  * constructor-initialization. eg:
6502  *
6503  * class MyClass :
6504  *	baseClass		<-- here
6505  * class MyClass : public baseClass,
6506  *	anotherBaseClass	<-- here (should probably lineup ??)
6507  * MyClass::MyClass(...) :
6508  *	baseClass(...)		<-- here (constructor-initialization)
6509  *
6510  * This is a lot of guessing.  Watch out for "cond ? func() : foo".
6511  */
6512     static int
6513 cin_is_cpp_baseclass(cached)
6514     cpp_baseclass_cache_T *cached; /* input and output */
6515 {
6516     lpos_T	*pos = &cached->lpos;	    /* find position */
6517     char_u	*s;
6518     int		class_or_struct, lookfor_ctor_init, cpp_base_class;
6519     linenr_T	lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
6520     char_u	*line = ml_get_curline();
6521 
6522     if (pos->lnum <= lnum)
6523 	return cached->found;	/* Use the cached result */
6524 
6525     pos->col = 0;
6526 
6527     s = skipwhite(line);
6528     if (*s == '#')		/* skip #define FOO x ? (x) : x */
6529 	return FALSE;
6530     s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6531     if (*s == NUL)
6532 	return FALSE;
6533 
6534     cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE;
6535 
6536     /* Search for a line starting with '#', empty, ending in ';' or containing
6537      * '{' or '}' and start below it.  This handles the following situations:
6538      *	a = cond ?
6539      *	      func() :
6540      *		   asdf;
6541      *	func::foo()
6542      *	      : something
6543      *	{}
6544      *	Foo::Foo (int one, int two)
6545      *		: something(4),
6546      *		somethingelse(3)
6547      *	{}
6548      */
6549     while (lnum > 1)
6550     {
6551 	line = ml_get(lnum - 1);
6552 	s = skipwhite(line);
6553 	if (*s == '#' || *s == NUL)
6554 	    break;
6555 	while (*s != NUL)
6556 	{
6557 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s);
6558 	    if (*s == '{' || *s == '}'
6559 		    || (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1)))
6560 		break;
6561 	    if (*s != NUL)
6562 		++s;
6563 	}
6564 	if (*s != NUL)
6565 	    break;
6566 	--lnum;
6567     }
6568 
6569     pos->lnum = lnum;
6570     line = ml_get(lnum);
6571     s = line;
6572     for (;;)
6573     {
6574 	if (*s == NUL)
6575 	{
6576 	    if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum)
6577 		break;
6578 	    /* Continue in the cursor line. */
6579 	    line = ml_get(++lnum);
6580 	    s = line;
6581 	}
6582 	if (s == line)
6583 	{
6584 	    /* don't recognize "case (foo):" as a baseclass */
6585 	    if (cin_iscase(s, FALSE))
6586 		break;
6587 	    s = cin_skipcomment(line);
6588 	    if (*s == NUL)
6589 		continue;
6590 	}
6591 
6592 	if (s[0] == '"' || (s[0] == 'R' && s[1] == '"'))
6593 	    s = skip_string(s) + 1;
6594 	else if (s[0] == ':')
6595 	{
6596 	    if (s[1] == ':')
6597 	    {
6598 		/* skip double colon. It can't be a constructor
6599 		 * initialization any more */
6600 		lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE;
6601 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + 2);
6602 	    }
6603 	    else if (lookfor_ctor_init || class_or_struct)
6604 	    {
6605 		/* we have something found, that looks like the start of
6606 		 * cpp-base-class-declaration or constructor-initialization */
6607 		cpp_base_class = TRUE;
6608 		lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE;
6609 		pos->col = 0;
6610 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1);
6611 	    }
6612 	    else
6613 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1);
6614 	}
6615 	else if ((STRNCMP(s, "class", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[5]))
6616 		|| (STRNCMP(s, "struct", 6) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[6])))
6617 	{
6618 	    class_or_struct = TRUE;
6619 	    lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE;
6620 
6621 	    if (*s == 'c')
6622 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + 5);
6623 	    else
6624 		s = cin_skipcomment(s + 6);
6625 	}
6626 	else
6627 	{
6628 	    if (s[0] == '{' || s[0] == '}' || s[0] == ';')
6629 	    {
6630 		cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE;
6631 	    }
6632 	    else if (s[0] == ')')
6633 	    {
6634 		/* Constructor-initialization is assumed if we come across
6635 		 * something like "):" */
6636 		class_or_struct = FALSE;
6637 		lookfor_ctor_init = TRUE;
6638 	    }
6639 	    else if (s[0] == '?')
6640 	    {
6641 		/* Avoid seeing '() :' after '?' as constructor init. */
6642 		return FALSE;
6643 	    }
6644 	    else if (!vim_isIDc(s[0]))
6645 	    {
6646 		/* if it is not an identifier, we are wrong */
6647 		class_or_struct = FALSE;
6648 		lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE;
6649 	    }
6650 	    else if (pos->col == 0)
6651 	    {
6652 		/* it can't be a constructor-initialization any more */
6653 		lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE;
6654 
6655 		/* the first statement starts here: lineup with this one... */
6656 		if (cpp_base_class)
6657 		    pos->col = (colnr_T)(s - line);
6658 	    }
6659 
6660 	    /* When the line ends in a comma don't align with it. */
6661 	    if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum && *s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1))
6662 		pos->col = 0;
6663 
6664 	    s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1);
6665 	}
6666     }
6667 
6668     cached->found = cpp_base_class;
6669     if (cpp_base_class)
6670 	pos->lnum = lnum;
6671     return cpp_base_class;
6672 }
6673 
6674     static int
6675 get_baseclass_amount(col)
6676     int		col;
6677 {
6678     int		amount;
6679     colnr_T	vcol;
6680     pos_T	*trypos;
6681 
6682     if (col == 0)
6683     {
6684 	amount = get_indent();
6685 	if (find_last_paren(ml_get_curline(), '(', ')')
6686 		&& (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
6687 	    amount = get_indent_lnum(trypos->lnum); /* XXX */
6688 	if (!cin_ends_in(ml_get_curline(), (char_u *)",", NULL))
6689 	    amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass;
6690     }
6691     else
6692     {
6693 	curwin->w_cursor.col = col;
6694 	getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, &vcol, NULL, NULL);
6695 	amount = (int)vcol;
6696     }
6697     if (amount < curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass)
6698 	amount = curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass;
6699     return amount;
6700 }
6701 
6702 /*
6703  * Return TRUE if string "s" ends with the string "find", possibly followed by
6704  * white space and comments.  Skip strings and comments.
6705  * Ignore "ignore" after "find" if it's not NULL.
6706  */
6707     static int
6708 cin_ends_in(s, find, ignore)
6709     char_u	*s;
6710     char_u	*find;
6711     char_u	*ignore;
6712 {
6713     char_u	*p = s;
6714     char_u	*r;
6715     int		len = (int)STRLEN(find);
6716 
6717     while (*p != NUL)
6718     {
6719 	p = cin_skipcomment(p);
6720 	if (STRNCMP(p, find, len) == 0)
6721 	{
6722 	    r = skipwhite(p + len);
6723 	    if (ignore != NULL && STRNCMP(r, ignore, STRLEN(ignore)) == 0)
6724 		r = skipwhite(r + STRLEN(ignore));
6725 	    if (cin_nocode(r))
6726 		return TRUE;
6727 	}
6728 	if (*p != NUL)
6729 	    ++p;
6730     }
6731     return FALSE;
6732 }
6733 
6734 /*
6735  * Return TRUE when "s" starts with "word" and then a non-ID character.
6736  */
6737     static int
6738 cin_starts_with(s, word)
6739     char_u *s;
6740     char *word;
6741 {
6742     int l = (int)STRLEN(word);
6743 
6744     return (STRNCMP(s, word, l) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[l]));
6745 }
6746 
6747 /*
6748  * Skip strings, chars and comments until at or past "trypos".
6749  * Return the column found.
6750  */
6751     static int
6752 cin_skip2pos(trypos)
6753     pos_T	*trypos;
6754 {
6755     char_u	*line;
6756     char_u	*p;
6757 
6758     p = line = ml_get(trypos->lnum);
6759     while (*p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < trypos->col)
6760     {
6761 	if (cin_iscomment(p))
6762 	    p = cin_skipcomment(p);
6763 	else
6764 	{
6765 	    p = skip_string(p);
6766 	    ++p;
6767 	}
6768     }
6769     return (int)(p - line);
6770 }
6771 
6772 /*
6773  * Find the '{' at the start of the block we are in.
6774  * Return NULL if no match found.
6775  * Ignore a '{' that is in a comment, makes indenting the next three lines
6776  * work. */
6777 /* foo()    */
6778 /* {	    */
6779 /* }	    */
6780 
6781     static pos_T *
6782 find_start_brace()	    /* XXX */
6783 {
6784     pos_T	cursor_save;
6785     pos_T	*trypos;
6786     pos_T	*pos;
6787     static pos_T	pos_copy;
6788 
6789     cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
6790     while ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '{', FM_BLOCKSTOP, 0)) != NULL)
6791     {
6792 	pos_copy = *trypos;	/* copy pos_T, next findmatch will change it */
6793 	trypos = &pos_copy;
6794 	curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
6795 	pos = NULL;
6796 	/* ignore the { if it's in a // or / *  * / comment */
6797 	if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) == trypos->col
6798 		       && (pos = ind_find_start_CORS()) == NULL) /* XXX */
6799 	    break;
6800 	if (pos != NULL)
6801 	    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum;
6802     }
6803     curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
6804     return trypos;
6805 }
6806 
6807 /*
6808  * Find the matching '(', ignoring it if it is in a comment.
6809  * Return NULL if no match found.
6810  */
6811     static pos_T *
6812 find_match_paren(ind_maxparen)	    /* XXX */
6813     int		ind_maxparen;
6814 {
6815     return find_match_char('(', ind_maxparen);
6816 }
6817 
6818     static pos_T *
6819 find_match_char(c, ind_maxparen)	    /* XXX */
6820     int		c;
6821     int		ind_maxparen;
6822 {
6823     pos_T	cursor_save;
6824     pos_T	*trypos;
6825     static pos_T pos_copy;
6826     int		ind_maxp_wk;
6827 
6828     cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
6829     ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen;
6830 retry:
6831     if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, c, 0, ind_maxp_wk)) != NULL)
6832     {
6833 	/* check if the ( is in a // comment */
6834 	if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) > trypos->col)
6835 	{
6836 	    ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen - (int)(cursor_save.lnum - trypos->lnum);
6837 	    if (ind_maxp_wk > 0)
6838 	    {
6839 		curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
6840 		curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;	/* XXX */
6841 		goto retry;
6842 	    }
6843 	    trypos = NULL;
6844 	}
6845 	else
6846 	{
6847 	    pos_T	*trypos_wk;
6848 
6849 	    pos_copy = *trypos;	    /* copy trypos, findmatch will change it */
6850 	    trypos = &pos_copy;
6851 	    curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
6852 	    if ((trypos_wk = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) /* XXX */
6853 	    {
6854 		ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen - (int)(cursor_save.lnum
6855 			- trypos_wk->lnum);
6856 		if (ind_maxp_wk > 0)
6857 		{
6858 		    curwin->w_cursor = *trypos_wk;
6859 		    goto retry;
6860 		}
6861 		trypos = NULL;
6862 	    }
6863 	}
6864     }
6865     curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
6866     return trypos;
6867 }
6868 
6869 /*
6870  * Find the matching '(', ignoring it if it is in a comment or before an
6871  * unmatched {.
6872  * Return NULL if no match found.
6873  */
6874     static pos_T *
6875 find_match_paren_after_brace(ind_maxparen)	    /* XXX */
6876     int		ind_maxparen;
6877 {
6878     pos_T	*trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen);
6879 
6880     if (trypos != NULL)
6881     {
6882 	pos_T	*tryposBrace = find_start_brace();
6883 
6884 	/* If both an unmatched '(' and '{' is found.  Ignore the '('
6885 	 * position if the '{' is further down. */
6886 	if (tryposBrace != NULL
6887 		&& (trypos->lnum != tryposBrace->lnum
6888 		    ? trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum
6889 		    : trypos->col < tryposBrace->col))
6890 	    trypos = NULL;
6891     }
6892     return trypos;
6893 }
6894 
6895 /*
6896  * Return ind_maxparen corrected for the difference in line number between the
6897  * cursor position and "startpos".  This makes sure that searching for a
6898  * matching paren above the cursor line doesn't find a match because of
6899  * looking a few lines further.
6900  */
6901     static int
6902 corr_ind_maxparen(startpos)
6903     pos_T	*startpos;
6904 {
6905     long	n = (long)startpos->lnum - (long)curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
6906 
6907     if (n > 0 && n < curbuf->b_ind_maxparen / 2)
6908 	return curbuf->b_ind_maxparen - (int)n;
6909     return curbuf->b_ind_maxparen;
6910 }
6911 
6912 /*
6913  * Set w_cursor.col to the column number of the last unmatched ')' or '{' in
6914  * line "l".  "l" must point to the start of the line.
6915  */
6916     static int
6917 find_last_paren(l, start, end)
6918     char_u	*l;
6919     int		start, end;
6920 {
6921     int		i;
6922     int		retval = FALSE;
6923     int		open_count = 0;
6924 
6925     curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;		    /* default is start of line */
6926 
6927     for (i = 0; l[i] != NUL; i++)
6928     {
6929 	i = (int)(cin_skipcomment(l + i) - l); /* ignore parens in comments */
6930 	i = (int)(skip_string(l + i) - l);    /* ignore parens in quotes */
6931 	if (l[i] == start)
6932 	    ++open_count;
6933 	else if (l[i] == end)
6934 	{
6935 	    if (open_count > 0)
6936 		--open_count;
6937 	    else
6938 	    {
6939 		curwin->w_cursor.col = i;
6940 		retval = TRUE;
6941 	    }
6942 	}
6943     }
6944     return retval;
6945 }
6946 
6947 /*
6948  * Parse 'cinoptions' and set the values in "curbuf".
6949  * Must be called when 'cinoptions', 'shiftwidth' and/or 'tabstop' changes.
6950  */
6951     void
6952 parse_cino(buf)
6953     buf_T	*buf;
6954 {
6955     char_u	*p;
6956     char_u	*l;
6957     char_u	*digits;
6958     int		n;
6959     int		divider;
6960     int		fraction = 0;
6961     int		sw = (int)get_sw_value(buf);
6962 
6963     /*
6964      * Set the default values.
6965      */
6966     /* Spaces from a block's opening brace the prevailing indent for that
6967      * block should be. */
6968     buf->b_ind_level = sw;
6969 
6970     /* Spaces from the edge of the line an open brace that's at the end of a
6971      * line is imagined to be. */
6972     buf->b_ind_open_imag = 0;
6973 
6974     /* Spaces from the prevailing indent for a line that is not preceded by
6975      * an opening brace. */
6976     buf->b_ind_no_brace = 0;
6977 
6978     /* Column where the first { of a function should be located }. */
6979     buf->b_ind_first_open = 0;
6980 
6981     /* Spaces from the prevailing indent a leftmost open brace should be
6982      * located. */
6983     buf->b_ind_open_extra = 0;
6984 
6985     /* Spaces from the matching open brace (real location for one at the left
6986      * edge; imaginary location from one that ends a line) the matching close
6987      * brace should be located. */
6988     buf->b_ind_close_extra = 0;
6989 
6990     /* Spaces from the edge of the line an open brace sitting in the leftmost
6991      * column is imagined to be. */
6992     buf->b_ind_open_left_imag = 0;
6993 
6994     /* Spaces jump labels should be shifted to the left if N is non-negative,
6995      * otherwise the jump label will be put to column 1. */
6996     buf->b_ind_jump_label = -1;
6997 
6998     /* Spaces from the switch() indent a "case xx" label should be located. */
6999     buf->b_ind_case = sw;
7000 
7001     /* Spaces from the "case xx:" code after a switch() should be located. */
7002     buf->b_ind_case_code = sw;
7003 
7004     /* Lineup break at end of case in switch() with case label. */
7005     buf->b_ind_case_break = 0;
7006 
7007     /* Spaces from the class declaration indent a scope declaration label
7008      * should be located. */
7009     buf->b_ind_scopedecl = sw;
7010 
7011     /* Spaces from the scope declaration label code should be located. */
7012     buf->b_ind_scopedecl_code = sw;
7013 
7014     /* Amount K&R-style parameters should be indented. */
7015     buf->b_ind_param = sw;
7016 
7017     /* Amount a function type spec should be indented. */
7018     buf->b_ind_func_type = sw;
7019 
7020     /* Amount a cpp base class declaration or constructor initialization
7021      * should be indented. */
7022     buf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass = sw;
7023 
7024     /* additional spaces beyond the prevailing indent a continuation line
7025      * should be located. */
7026     buf->b_ind_continuation = sw;
7027 
7028     /* Spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses. */
7029     buf->b_ind_unclosed = sw * 2;
7030 
7031     /* Spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses, which
7032      * itself is also unclosed. */
7033     buf->b_ind_unclosed2 = sw;
7034 
7035     /* Suppress ignoring spaces from the indent of a line starting with an
7036      * unclosed parentheses. */
7037     buf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore = 0;
7038 
7039     /* If the opening paren is the last nonwhite character on the line, and
7040      * b_ind_unclosed_wrapped is nonzero, use this indent relative to the outer
7041      * context (for very long lines). */
7042     buf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped = 0;
7043 
7044     /* Suppress ignoring white space when lining up with the character after
7045      * an unclosed parentheses. */
7046     buf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok = 0;
7047 
7048     /* Indent a closing parentheses under the line start of the matching
7049      * opening parentheses. */
7050     buf->b_ind_matching_paren = 0;
7051 
7052     /* Indent a closing parentheses under the previous line. */
7053     buf->b_ind_paren_prev = 0;
7054 
7055     /* Extra indent for comments. */
7056     buf->b_ind_comment = 0;
7057 
7058     /* Spaces from the comment opener when there is nothing after it. */
7059     buf->b_ind_in_comment = 3;
7060 
7061     /* Boolean: if non-zero, use b_ind_in_comment even if there is something
7062      * after the comment opener. */
7063     buf->b_ind_in_comment2 = 0;
7064 
7065     /* Max lines to search for an open paren. */
7066     buf->b_ind_maxparen = 20;
7067 
7068     /* Max lines to search for an open comment. */
7069     buf->b_ind_maxcomment = 70;
7070 
7071     /* Handle braces for java code. */
7072     buf->b_ind_java = 0;
7073 
7074     /* Not to confuse JS object properties with labels. */
7075     buf->b_ind_js = 0;
7076 
7077     /* Handle blocked cases correctly. */
7078     buf->b_ind_keep_case_label = 0;
7079 
7080     /* Handle C++ namespace. */
7081     buf->b_ind_cpp_namespace = 0;
7082 
7083     /* Handle continuation lines containing conditions of if(), for() and
7084      * while(). */
7085     buf->b_ind_if_for_while = 0;
7086 
7087     for (p = buf->b_p_cino; *p; )
7088     {
7089 	l = p++;
7090 	if (*p == '-')
7091 	    ++p;
7092 	digits = p;	    /* remember where the digits start */
7093 	n = getdigits(&p);
7094 	divider = 0;
7095 	if (*p == '.')	    /* ".5s" means a fraction */
7096 	{
7097 	    fraction = atol((char *)++p);
7098 	    while (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p))
7099 	    {
7100 		++p;
7101 		if (divider)
7102 		    divider *= 10;
7103 		else
7104 		    divider = 10;
7105 	    }
7106 	}
7107 	if (*p == 's')	    /* "2s" means two times 'shiftwidth' */
7108 	{
7109 	    if (p == digits)
7110 		n = sw;	/* just "s" is one 'shiftwidth' */
7111 	    else
7112 	    {
7113 		n *= sw;
7114 		if (divider)
7115 		    n += (sw * fraction + divider / 2) / divider;
7116 	    }
7117 	    ++p;
7118 	}
7119 	if (l[1] == '-')
7120 	    n = -n;
7121 
7122 	/* When adding an entry here, also update the default 'cinoptions' in
7123 	 * doc/indent.txt, and add explanation for it! */
7124 	switch (*l)
7125 	{
7126 	    case '>': buf->b_ind_level = n; break;
7127 	    case 'e': buf->b_ind_open_imag = n; break;
7128 	    case 'n': buf->b_ind_no_brace = n; break;
7129 	    case 'f': buf->b_ind_first_open = n; break;
7130 	    case '{': buf->b_ind_open_extra = n; break;
7131 	    case '}': buf->b_ind_close_extra = n; break;
7132 	    case '^': buf->b_ind_open_left_imag = n; break;
7133 	    case 'L': buf->b_ind_jump_label = n; break;
7134 	    case ':': buf->b_ind_case = n; break;
7135 	    case '=': buf->b_ind_case_code = n; break;
7136 	    case 'b': buf->b_ind_case_break = n; break;
7137 	    case 'p': buf->b_ind_param = n; break;
7138 	    case 't': buf->b_ind_func_type = n; break;
7139 	    case '/': buf->b_ind_comment = n; break;
7140 	    case 'c': buf->b_ind_in_comment = n; break;
7141 	    case 'C': buf->b_ind_in_comment2 = n; break;
7142 	    case 'i': buf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass = n; break;
7143 	    case '+': buf->b_ind_continuation = n; break;
7144 	    case '(': buf->b_ind_unclosed = n; break;
7145 	    case 'u': buf->b_ind_unclosed2 = n; break;
7146 	    case 'U': buf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore = n; break;
7147 	    case 'W': buf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped = n; break;
7148 	    case 'w': buf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok = n; break;
7149 	    case 'm': buf->b_ind_matching_paren = n; break;
7150 	    case 'M': buf->b_ind_paren_prev = n; break;
7151 	    case ')': buf->b_ind_maxparen = n; break;
7152 	    case '*': buf->b_ind_maxcomment = n; break;
7153 	    case 'g': buf->b_ind_scopedecl = n; break;
7154 	    case 'h': buf->b_ind_scopedecl_code = n; break;
7155 	    case 'j': buf->b_ind_java = n; break;
7156 	    case 'J': buf->b_ind_js = n; break;
7157 	    case 'l': buf->b_ind_keep_case_label = n; break;
7158 	    case '#': buf->b_ind_hash_comment = n; break;
7159 	    case 'N': buf->b_ind_cpp_namespace = n; break;
7160 	    case 'k': buf->b_ind_if_for_while = n; break;
7161 	}
7162 	if (*p == ',')
7163 	    ++p;
7164     }
7165 }
7166 
7167 /*
7168  * Return the desired indent for C code.
7169  * Return -1 if the indent should be left alone (inside a raw string).
7170  */
7171     int
7172 get_c_indent()
7173 {
7174     pos_T	cur_curpos;
7175     int		amount;
7176     int		scope_amount;
7177     int		cur_amount = MAXCOL;
7178     colnr_T	col;
7179     char_u	*theline;
7180     char_u	*linecopy;
7181     pos_T	*trypos;
7182     pos_T	*comment_pos;
7183     pos_T	*tryposBrace = NULL;
7184     pos_T	tryposCopy;
7185     pos_T	our_paren_pos;
7186     char_u	*start;
7187     int		start_brace;
7188 #define BRACE_IN_COL0		1	    /* '{' is in column 0 */
7189 #define BRACE_AT_START		2	    /* '{' is at start of line */
7190 #define BRACE_AT_END		3	    /* '{' is at end of line */
7191     linenr_T	ourscope;
7192     char_u	*l;
7193     char_u	*look;
7194     char_u	terminated;
7195     int		lookfor;
7196 #define LOOKFOR_INITIAL		0
7197 #define LOOKFOR_IF		1
7198 #define LOOKFOR_DO		2
7199 #define LOOKFOR_CASE		3
7200 #define LOOKFOR_ANY		4
7201 #define LOOKFOR_TERM		5
7202 #define LOOKFOR_UNTERM		6
7203 #define LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL	7
7204 #define LOOKFOR_NOBREAK		8
7205 #define LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS	9
7206 #define LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT	10
7207 #define LOOKFOR_JS_KEY		11
7208 #define LOOKFOR_COMMA		12
7209 
7210     int		whilelevel;
7211     linenr_T	lnum;
7212     int		n;
7213     int		iscase;
7214     int		lookfor_break;
7215     int		lookfor_cpp_namespace = FALSE;
7216     int		cont_amount = 0;    /* amount for continuation line */
7217     int		original_line_islabel;
7218     int		added_to_amount = 0;
7219     int		js_cur_has_key = 0;
7220     cpp_baseclass_cache_T cache_cpp_baseclass = { FALSE, { MAXLNUM, 0 } };
7221 
7222     /* make a copy, value is changed below */
7223     int		ind_continuation = curbuf->b_ind_continuation;
7224 
7225     /* remember where the cursor was when we started */
7226     cur_curpos = curwin->w_cursor;
7227 
7228     /* if we are at line 1 zero indent is fine, right? */
7229     if (cur_curpos.lnum == 1)
7230 	return 0;
7231 
7232     /* Get a copy of the current contents of the line.
7233      * This is required, because only the most recent line obtained with
7234      * ml_get is valid! */
7235     linecopy = vim_strsave(ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum));
7236     if (linecopy == NULL)
7237 	return 0;
7238 
7239     /*
7240      * In insert mode and the cursor is on a ')' truncate the line at the
7241      * cursor position.  We don't want to line up with the matching '(' when
7242      * inserting new stuff.
7243      * For unknown reasons the cursor might be past the end of the line, thus
7244      * check for that.
7245      */
7246     if ((State & INSERT)
7247 	    && curwin->w_cursor.col < (colnr_T)STRLEN(linecopy)
7248 	    && linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] == ')')
7249 	linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL;
7250 
7251     theline = skipwhite(linecopy);
7252 
7253     /* move the cursor to the start of the line */
7254 
7255     curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
7256 
7257     original_line_islabel = cin_islabel();  /* XXX */
7258 
7259     /*
7260      * If we are inside a raw string don't change the indent.
7261      * Ignore a raw string inside a comment.
7262      */
7263     comment_pos = ind_find_start_comment();
7264     if (comment_pos != NULL)
7265     {
7266 	/* findmatchlimit() static pos is overwritten, make a copy */
7267 	tryposCopy = *comment_pos;
7268 	comment_pos = &tryposCopy;
7269     }
7270     trypos = find_start_rawstring(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment);
7271     if (trypos != NULL && (comment_pos == NULL || lt(*trypos, *comment_pos)))
7272     {
7273 	amount = -1;
7274 	goto laterend;
7275     }
7276 
7277     /*
7278      * #defines and so on always go at the left when included in 'cinkeys'.
7279      */
7280     if (*theline == '#' && (*linecopy == '#' || in_cinkeys('#', ' ', TRUE)))
7281     {
7282 	amount = curbuf->b_ind_hash_comment;
7283 	goto theend;
7284     }
7285 
7286     /*
7287      * Is it a non-case label?	Then that goes at the left margin too unless:
7288      *  - JS flag is set.
7289      *  - 'L' item has a positive value.
7290      */
7291     if (original_line_islabel && !curbuf->b_ind_js
7292 					      && curbuf->b_ind_jump_label < 0)
7293     {
7294 	amount = 0;
7295 	goto theend;
7296     }
7297 
7298     /*
7299      * If we're inside a "//" comment and there is a "//" comment in a
7300      * previous line, lineup with that one.
7301      */
7302     if (cin_islinecomment(theline)
7303 	    && (trypos = find_line_comment()) != NULL) /* XXX */
7304     {
7305 	/* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */
7306 	getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL);
7307 	amount = col;
7308 	goto theend;
7309     }
7310 
7311     /*
7312      * If we're inside a comment and not looking at the start of the
7313      * comment, try using the 'comments' option.
7314      */
7315     if (!cin_iscomment(theline) && comment_pos != NULL) /* XXX */
7316     {
7317 	int	lead_start_len = 2;
7318 	int	lead_middle_len = 1;
7319 	char_u	lead_start[COM_MAX_LEN];	/* start-comment string */
7320 	char_u	lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN];	/* middle-comment string */
7321 	char_u	lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN];		/* end-comment string */
7322 	char_u	*p;
7323 	int	start_align = 0;
7324 	int	start_off = 0;
7325 	int	done = FALSE;
7326 
7327 	/* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */
7328 	getvcol(curwin, comment_pos, &col, NULL, NULL);
7329 	amount = col;
7330 	*lead_start = NUL;
7331 	*lead_middle = NUL;
7332 
7333 	p = curbuf->b_p_com;
7334 	while (*p != NUL)
7335 	{
7336 	    int	align = 0;
7337 	    int	off = 0;
7338 	    int what = 0;
7339 
7340 	    while (*p != NUL && *p != ':')
7341 	    {
7342 		if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_END || *p == COM_MIDDLE)
7343 		    what = *p++;
7344 		else if (*p == COM_LEFT || *p == COM_RIGHT)
7345 		    align = *p++;
7346 		else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-')
7347 		    off = getdigits(&p);
7348 		else
7349 		    ++p;
7350 	    }
7351 
7352 	    if (*p == ':')
7353 		++p;
7354 	    (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ",");
7355 	    if (what == COM_START)
7356 	    {
7357 		STRCPY(lead_start, lead_end);
7358 		lead_start_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_start);
7359 		start_off = off;
7360 		start_align = align;
7361 	    }
7362 	    else if (what == COM_MIDDLE)
7363 	    {
7364 		STRCPY(lead_middle, lead_end);
7365 		lead_middle_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle);
7366 	    }
7367 	    else if (what == COM_END)
7368 	    {
7369 		/* If our line starts with the middle comment string, line it
7370 		 * up with the comment opener per the 'comments' option. */
7371 		if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) == 0
7372 			&& STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) != 0)
7373 		{
7374 		    done = TRUE;
7375 		    if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
7376 		    {
7377 			/* If the start comment string matches in the previous
7378 			 * line, use the indent of that line plus offset.  If
7379 			 * the middle comment string matches in the previous
7380 			 * line, use the indent of that line.  XXX */
7381 			look = skipwhite(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1));
7382 			if (STRNCMP(look, lead_start, lead_start_len) == 0)
7383 			    amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
7384 			else if (STRNCMP(look, lead_middle,
7385 							lead_middle_len) == 0)
7386 			{
7387 			    amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
7388 			    break;
7389 			}
7390 			/* If the start comment string doesn't match with the
7391 			 * start of the comment, skip this entry. XXX */
7392 			else if (STRNCMP(ml_get(comment_pos->lnum) + comment_pos->col,
7393 					     lead_start, lead_start_len) != 0)
7394 			    continue;
7395 		    }
7396 		    if (start_off != 0)
7397 			amount += start_off;
7398 		    else if (start_align == COM_RIGHT)
7399 			amount += vim_strsize(lead_start)
7400 						   - vim_strsize(lead_middle);
7401 		    break;
7402 		}
7403 
7404 		/* If our line starts with the end comment string, line it up
7405 		 * with the middle comment */
7406 		if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) != 0
7407 			&& STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) == 0)
7408 		{
7409 		    amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
7410 								     /* XXX */
7411 		    if (off != 0)
7412 			amount += off;
7413 		    else if (align == COM_RIGHT)
7414 			amount += vim_strsize(lead_start)
7415 						   - vim_strsize(lead_middle);
7416 		    done = TRUE;
7417 		    break;
7418 		}
7419 	    }
7420 	}
7421 
7422 	/* If our line starts with an asterisk, line up with the
7423 	 * asterisk in the comment opener; otherwise, line up
7424 	 * with the first character of the comment text.
7425 	 */
7426 	if (done)
7427 	    ;
7428 	else if (theline[0] == '*')
7429 	    amount += 1;
7430 	else
7431 	{
7432 	    /*
7433 	     * If we are more than one line away from the comment opener, take
7434 	     * the indent of the previous non-empty line.  If 'cino' has "CO"
7435 	     * and we are just below the comment opener and there are any
7436 	     * white characters after it line up with the text after it;
7437 	     * otherwise, add the amount specified by "c" in 'cino'
7438 	     */
7439 	    amount = -1;
7440 	    for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > comment_pos->lnum; --lnum)
7441 	    {
7442 		if (linewhite(lnum))		    /* skip blank lines */
7443 		    continue;
7444 		amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum);	    /* XXX */
7445 		break;
7446 	    }
7447 	    if (amount == -1)			    /* use the comment opener */
7448 	    {
7449 		if (!curbuf->b_ind_in_comment2)
7450 		{
7451 		    start = ml_get(comment_pos->lnum);
7452 		    look = start + comment_pos->col + 2; /* skip / and * */
7453 		    if (*look != NUL)		    /* if something after it */
7454 			comment_pos->col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(look) - start);
7455 		}
7456 		getvcol(curwin, comment_pos, &col, NULL, NULL);
7457 		amount = col;
7458 		if (curbuf->b_ind_in_comment2 || *look == NUL)
7459 		    amount += curbuf->b_ind_in_comment;
7460 	    }
7461 	}
7462 	goto theend;
7463     }
7464 
7465     /*
7466      * Are we looking at a ']' that has a match?
7467      */
7468     if (*skipwhite(theline) == ']'
7469 	    && (trypos = find_match_char('[', curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
7470     {
7471 	/* align with the line containing the '['. */
7472 	amount = get_indent_lnum(trypos->lnum);
7473 	goto theend;
7474     }
7475 
7476     /*
7477      * Are we inside parentheses or braces?
7478      */						    /* XXX */
7479     if (((trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL
7480 		&& curbuf->b_ind_java == 0)
7481 	    || (tryposBrace = find_start_brace()) != NULL
7482 	    || trypos != NULL)
7483     {
7484       if (trypos != NULL && tryposBrace != NULL)
7485       {
7486 	  /* Both an unmatched '(' and '{' is found.  Use the one which is
7487 	   * closer to the current cursor position, set the other to NULL. */
7488 	  if (trypos->lnum != tryposBrace->lnum
7489 		  ? trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum
7490 		  : trypos->col < tryposBrace->col)
7491 	      trypos = NULL;
7492 	  else
7493 	      tryposBrace = NULL;
7494       }
7495 
7496       if (trypos != NULL)
7497       {
7498 	/*
7499 	 * If the matching paren is more than one line away, use the indent of
7500 	 * a previous non-empty line that matches the same paren.
7501 	 */
7502 	if (theline[0] == ')' && curbuf->b_ind_paren_prev)
7503 	{
7504 	    /* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */
7505 	    amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);  /* XXX */
7506 	}
7507 	else
7508 	{
7509 	    amount = -1;
7510 	    our_paren_pos = *trypos;
7511 	    for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > our_paren_pos.lnum; --lnum)
7512 	    {
7513 		l = skipwhite(ml_get(lnum));
7514 		if (cin_nocode(l))		/* skip comment lines */
7515 		    continue;
7516 		if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &lnum))
7517 		    continue;			/* ignore #define, #if, etc. */
7518 		curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum;
7519 
7520 		/* Skip a comment or raw string. XXX */
7521 		if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL)
7522 		{
7523 		    lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
7524 		    continue;
7525 		}
7526 
7527 		/* XXX */
7528 		if ((trypos = find_match_paren(
7529 			corr_ind_maxparen(&cur_curpos))) != NULL
7530 			&& trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum
7531 			&& trypos->col == our_paren_pos.col)
7532 		{
7533 			amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum);	/* XXX */
7534 
7535 			if (theline[0] == ')')
7536 			{
7537 			    if (our_paren_pos.lnum != lnum
7538 						       && cur_amount > amount)
7539 				cur_amount = amount;
7540 			    amount = -1;
7541 			}
7542 		    break;
7543 		}
7544 	    }
7545 	}
7546 
7547 	/*
7548 	 * Line up with line where the matching paren is. XXX
7549 	 * If the line starts with a '(' or the indent for unclosed
7550 	 * parentheses is zero, line up with the unclosed parentheses.
7551 	 */
7552 	if (amount == -1)
7553 	{
7554 	    int	    ignore_paren_col = 0;
7555 	    int	    is_if_for_while = 0;
7556 
7557 	    if (curbuf->b_ind_if_for_while)
7558 	    {
7559 		/* Look for the outermost opening parenthesis on this line
7560 		 * and check whether it belongs to an "if", "for" or "while". */
7561 
7562 		pos_T	    cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor;
7563 		pos_T	    outermost;
7564 		char_u	    *line;
7565 
7566 		trypos = &our_paren_pos;
7567 		do {
7568 		    outermost = *trypos;
7569 		    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = outermost.lnum;
7570 		    curwin->w_cursor.col = outermost.col;
7571 
7572 		    trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen);
7573 		} while (trypos && trypos->lnum == outermost.lnum);
7574 
7575 		curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save;
7576 
7577 		line = ml_get(outermost.lnum);
7578 
7579 		is_if_for_while =
7580 		    cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, &outermost.col);
7581 	    }
7582 
7583 	    amount = skip_label(our_paren_pos.lnum, &look);
7584 	    look = skipwhite(look);
7585 	    if (*look == '(')
7586 	    {
7587 		linenr_T    save_lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
7588 		char_u	    *line;
7589 		int	    look_col;
7590 
7591 		/* Ignore a '(' in front of the line that has a match before
7592 		 * our matching '('. */
7593 		curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum;
7594 		line = ml_get_curline();
7595 		look_col = (int)(look - line);
7596 		curwin->w_cursor.col = look_col + 1;
7597 		if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, ')', 0,
7598 						      curbuf->b_ind_maxparen))
7599 								      != NULL
7600 			  && trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum
7601 			  && trypos->col < our_paren_pos.col)
7602 		    ignore_paren_col = trypos->col + 1;
7603 
7604 		curwin->w_cursor.lnum = save_lnum;
7605 		look = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum) + look_col;
7606 	    }
7607 	    if (theline[0] == ')' || (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed == 0
7608 						      && is_if_for_while == 0)
7609 		    || (!curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore && *look == '('
7610 						    && ignore_paren_col == 0))
7611 	    {
7612 		/*
7613 		 * If we're looking at a close paren, line up right there;
7614 		 * otherwise, line up with the next (non-white) character.
7615 		 * When b_ind_unclosed_wrapped is set and the matching paren is
7616 		 * the last nonwhite character of the line, use either the
7617 		 * indent of the current line or the indentation of the next
7618 		 * outer paren and add b_ind_unclosed_wrapped (for very long
7619 		 * lines).
7620 		 */
7621 		if (theline[0] != ')')
7622 		{
7623 		    cur_amount = MAXCOL;
7624 		    l = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum);
7625 		    if (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped
7626 				       && cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"(", NULL))
7627 		    {
7628 			/* look for opening unmatched paren, indent one level
7629 			 * for each additional level */
7630 			n = 1;
7631 			for (col = 0; col < our_paren_pos.col; ++col)
7632 			{
7633 			    switch (l[col])
7634 			    {
7635 				case '(':
7636 				case '{': ++n;
7637 					  break;
7638 
7639 				case ')':
7640 				case '}': if (n > 1)
7641 					      --n;
7642 					  break;
7643 			    }
7644 			}
7645 
7646 			our_paren_pos.col = 0;
7647 			amount += n * curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped;
7648 		    }
7649 		    else if (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok)
7650 			our_paren_pos.col++;
7651 		    else
7652 		    {
7653 			col = our_paren_pos.col + 1;
7654 			while (vim_iswhite(l[col]))
7655 			    col++;
7656 			if (l[col] != NUL)	/* In case of trailing space */
7657 			    our_paren_pos.col = col;
7658 			else
7659 			    our_paren_pos.col++;
7660 		    }
7661 		}
7662 
7663 		/*
7664 		 * Find how indented the paren is, or the character after it
7665 		 * if we did the above "if".
7666 		 */
7667 		if (our_paren_pos.col > 0)
7668 		{
7669 		    getvcol(curwin, &our_paren_pos, &col, NULL, NULL);
7670 		    if (cur_amount > (int)col)
7671 			cur_amount = col;
7672 		}
7673 	    }
7674 
7675 	    if (theline[0] == ')' && curbuf->b_ind_matching_paren)
7676 	    {
7677 		/* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */
7678 	    }
7679 	    else if ((curbuf->b_ind_unclosed == 0 && is_if_for_while == 0)
7680 		     || (!curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore
7681 				    && *look == '(' && ignore_paren_col == 0))
7682 	    {
7683 		if (cur_amount != MAXCOL)
7684 		    amount = cur_amount;
7685 	    }
7686 	    else
7687 	    {
7688 		/* Add b_ind_unclosed2 for each '(' before our matching one,
7689 		 * but ignore (void) before the line (ignore_paren_col). */
7690 		col = our_paren_pos.col;
7691 		while ((int)our_paren_pos.col > ignore_paren_col)
7692 		{
7693 		    --our_paren_pos.col;
7694 		    switch (*ml_get_pos(&our_paren_pos))
7695 		    {
7696 			case '(': amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2;
7697 				  col = our_paren_pos.col;
7698 				  break;
7699 			case ')': amount -= curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2;
7700 				  col = MAXCOL;
7701 				  break;
7702 		    }
7703 		}
7704 
7705 		/* Use b_ind_unclosed once, when the first '(' is not inside
7706 		 * braces */
7707 		if (col == MAXCOL)
7708 		    amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed;
7709 		else
7710 		{
7711 		    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum;
7712 		    curwin->w_cursor.col = col;
7713 		    if (find_match_paren_after_brace(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)
7714 								      != NULL)
7715 			amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2;
7716 		    else
7717 		    {
7718 			if (is_if_for_while)
7719 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_if_for_while;
7720 			else
7721 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed;
7722 		    }
7723 		}
7724 		/*
7725 		 * For a line starting with ')' use the minimum of the two
7726 		 * positions, to avoid giving it more indent than the previous
7727 		 * lines:
7728 		 *  func_long_name(		    if (x
7729 		 *	arg				    && yy
7730 		 *	)	  ^ not here	       )    ^ not here
7731 		 */
7732 		if (cur_amount < amount)
7733 		    amount = cur_amount;
7734 	    }
7735 	}
7736 
7737 	/* add extra indent for a comment */
7738 	if (cin_iscomment(theline))
7739 	    amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment;
7740       }
7741       else
7742       {
7743 	/*
7744 	 * We are inside braces, there is a { before this line at the position
7745 	 * stored in tryposBrace.
7746 	 * Make a copy of tryposBrace, it may point to pos_copy inside
7747 	 * find_start_brace(), which may be changed somewhere.
7748 	 */
7749 	tryposCopy = *tryposBrace;
7750 	tryposBrace = &tryposCopy;
7751 	trypos = tryposBrace;
7752 	ourscope = trypos->lnum;
7753 	start = ml_get(ourscope);
7754 
7755 	/*
7756 	 * Now figure out how indented the line is in general.
7757 	 * If the brace was at the start of the line, we use that;
7758 	 * otherwise, check out the indentation of the line as
7759 	 * a whole and then add the "imaginary indent" to that.
7760 	 */
7761 	look = skipwhite(start);
7762 	if (*look == '{')
7763 	{
7764 	    getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL);
7765 	    amount = col;
7766 	    if (*start == '{')
7767 		start_brace = BRACE_IN_COL0;
7768 	    else
7769 		start_brace = BRACE_AT_START;
7770 	}
7771 	else
7772 	{
7773 	    /* That opening brace might have been on a continuation
7774 	     * line.  if so, find the start of the line. */
7775 	    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = ourscope;
7776 
7777 	    /* Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that
7778 	     * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. */
7779 	    lnum = ourscope;
7780 	    if (find_last_paren(start, '(', ')')
7781 			&& (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen))
7782 								      != NULL)
7783 		lnum = trypos->lnum;
7784 
7785 	    /* It could have been something like
7786 	     *	   case 1: if (asdf &&
7787 	     *			ldfd) {
7788 	     *		    }
7789 	     */
7790 	    if ((curbuf->b_ind_js || curbuf->b_ind_keep_case_label)
7791 			   && cin_iscase(skipwhite(ml_get_curline()), FALSE))
7792 		amount = get_indent();
7793 	    else if (curbuf->b_ind_js)
7794 		amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum);
7795 	    else
7796 		amount = skip_label(lnum, &l);
7797 
7798 	    start_brace = BRACE_AT_END;
7799 	}
7800 
7801 	/* For Javascript check if the line starts with "key:". */
7802 	if (curbuf->b_ind_js)
7803 	    js_cur_has_key = cin_has_js_key(theline);
7804 
7805 	/*
7806 	 * If we're looking at a closing brace, that's where
7807 	 * we want to be.  otherwise, add the amount of room
7808 	 * that an indent is supposed to be.
7809 	 */
7810 	if (theline[0] == '}')
7811 	{
7812 	    /*
7813 	     * they may want closing braces to line up with something
7814 	     * other than the open brace.  indulge them, if so.
7815 	     */
7816 	    amount += curbuf->b_ind_close_extra;
7817 	}
7818 	else
7819 	{
7820 	    /*
7821 	     * If we're looking at an "else", try to find an "if"
7822 	     * to match it with.
7823 	     * If we're looking at a "while", try to find a "do"
7824 	     * to match it with.
7825 	     */
7826 	    lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL;
7827 	    if (cin_iselse(theline))
7828 		lookfor = LOOKFOR_IF;
7829 	    else if (cin_iswhileofdo(theline, cur_curpos.lnum)) /* XXX */
7830 		lookfor = LOOKFOR_DO;
7831 	    if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_INITIAL)
7832 	    {
7833 		curwin->w_cursor.lnum = cur_curpos.lnum;
7834 		if (find_match(lookfor, ourscope) == OK)
7835 		{
7836 		    amount = get_indent();	/* XXX */
7837 		    goto theend;
7838 		}
7839 	    }
7840 
7841 	    /*
7842 	     * We get here if we are not on an "while-of-do" or "else" (or
7843 	     * failed to find a matching "if").
7844 	     * Search backwards for something to line up with.
7845 	     * First set amount for when we don't find anything.
7846 	     */
7847 
7848 	    /*
7849 	     * if the '{' is  _really_ at the left margin, use the imaginary
7850 	     * location of a left-margin brace.  Otherwise, correct the
7851 	     * location for b_ind_open_extra.
7852 	     */
7853 
7854 	    if (start_brace == BRACE_IN_COL0)	    /* '{' is in column 0 */
7855 	    {
7856 		amount = curbuf->b_ind_open_left_imag;
7857 		lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE;
7858 	    }
7859 	    else if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_START &&
7860 		    lookfor_cpp_namespace)	  /* '{' is at start */
7861 	    {
7862 
7863 		lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE;
7864 	    }
7865 	    else
7866 	    {
7867 		if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_END)    /* '{' is at end of line */
7868 		{
7869 		    amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_imag;
7870 
7871 		    l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline());
7872 		    if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l))
7873 			amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_namespace;
7874 		}
7875 		else
7876 		{
7877 		    /* Compensate for adding b_ind_open_extra later. */
7878 		    amount -= curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
7879 		    if (amount < 0)
7880 			amount = 0;
7881 		}
7882 	    }
7883 
7884 	    lookfor_break = FALSE;
7885 
7886 	    if (cin_iscase(theline, FALSE))	/* it's a switch() label */
7887 	    {
7888 		lookfor = LOOKFOR_CASE;	/* find a previous switch() label */
7889 		amount += curbuf->b_ind_case;
7890 	    }
7891 	    else if (cin_isscopedecl(theline))	/* private:, ... */
7892 	    {
7893 		lookfor = LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL;	/* class decl is this block */
7894 		amount += curbuf->b_ind_scopedecl;
7895 	    }
7896 	    else
7897 	    {
7898 		if (curbuf->b_ind_case_break && cin_isbreak(theline))
7899 		    /* break; ... */
7900 		    lookfor_break = TRUE;
7901 
7902 		lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL;
7903 		/* b_ind_level from start of block */
7904 		amount += curbuf->b_ind_level;
7905 	    }
7906 	    scope_amount = amount;
7907 	    whilelevel = 0;
7908 
7909 	    /*
7910 	     * Search backwards.  If we find something we recognize, line up
7911 	     * with that.
7912 	     *
7913 	     * If we're looking at an open brace, indent
7914 	     * the usual amount relative to the conditional
7915 	     * that opens the block.
7916 	     */
7917 	    curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos;
7918 	    for (;;)
7919 	    {
7920 		curwin->w_cursor.lnum--;
7921 		curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
7922 
7923 		/*
7924 		 * If we went all the way back to the start of our scope, line
7925 		 * up with it.
7926 		 */
7927 		if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum <= ourscope)
7928 		{
7929 		    /* we reached end of scope:
7930 		     * if looking for a enum or structure initialization
7931 		     * go further back:
7932 		     * if it is an initializer (enum xxx or xxx =), then
7933 		     * don't add ind_continuation, otherwise it is a variable
7934 		     * declaration:
7935 		     * int x,
7936 		     *     here; <-- add ind_continuation
7937 		     */
7938 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
7939 		    {
7940 			if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0
7941 				|| curwin->w_cursor.lnum
7942 					  < ourscope - curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)
7943 			{
7944 			    /* nothing found (abuse curbuf->b_ind_maxparen as
7945 			     * limit) assume terminated line (i.e. a variable
7946 			     * initialization) */
7947 			    if (cont_amount > 0)
7948 				amount = cont_amount;
7949 			    else if (!curbuf->b_ind_js)
7950 				amount += ind_continuation;
7951 			    break;
7952 			}
7953 
7954 			l = ml_get_curline();
7955 
7956 			/*
7957 			 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to
7958 			 * the start of it.
7959 			 */
7960 			trypos = ind_find_start_CORS();
7961 			if (trypos != NULL)
7962 			{
7963 			    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
7964 			    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
7965 			    continue;
7966 			}
7967 
7968 			/*
7969 			 * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines.
7970 			 */
7971 			if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
7972 			    continue;
7973 
7974 			if (cin_nocode(l))
7975 			    continue;
7976 
7977 			terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE);
7978 
7979 			/*
7980 			 * If we are at top level and the line looks like a
7981 			 * function declaration, we are done
7982 			 * (it's a variable declaration).
7983 			 */
7984 			if (start_brace != BRACE_IN_COL0
7985 			     || !cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0))
7986 			{
7987 			    /* if the line is terminated with another ','
7988 			     * it is a continued variable initialization.
7989 			     * don't add extra indent.
7990 			     * TODO: does not work, if  a function
7991 			     * declaration is split over multiple lines:
7992 			     * cin_isfuncdecl returns FALSE then.
7993 			     */
7994 			    if (terminated == ',')
7995 				break;
7996 
7997 			    /* if it es a enum declaration or an assignment,
7998 			     * we are done.
7999 			     */
8000 			    if (terminated != ';' && cin_isinit())
8001 				break;
8002 
8003 			    /* nothing useful found */
8004 			    if (terminated == 0 || terminated == '{')
8005 				continue;
8006 			}
8007 
8008 			if (terminated != ';')
8009 			{
8010 			    /* Skip parens and braces. Position the cursor
8011 			     * over the rightmost paren, so that matching it
8012 			     * will take us back to the start of the line.
8013 			     */					/* XXX */
8014 			    trypos = NULL;
8015 			    if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')'))
8016 				trypos = find_match_paren(
8017 						      curbuf->b_ind_maxparen);
8018 
8019 			    if (trypos == NULL && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}'))
8020 				trypos = find_start_brace();
8021 
8022 			    if (trypos != NULL)
8023 			    {
8024 				curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
8025 				curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8026 				continue;
8027 			    }
8028 			}
8029 
8030 			/* it's a variable declaration, add indentation
8031 			 * like in
8032 			 * int a,
8033 			 *    b;
8034 			 */
8035 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8036 			    amount = cont_amount;
8037 			else
8038 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8039 		    }
8040 		    else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM)
8041 		    {
8042 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8043 			    amount = cont_amount;
8044 			else
8045 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8046 		    }
8047 		    else
8048 		    {
8049 			if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM
8050 					&& lookfor != LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS
8051 					&& lookfor != LOOKFOR_COMMA)
8052 			{
8053 			    amount = scope_amount;
8054 			    if (theline[0] == '{')
8055 			    {
8056 				amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8057 				added_to_amount = curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8058 			    }
8059 			}
8060 
8061 			if (lookfor_cpp_namespace)
8062 			{
8063 			    /*
8064 			     * Looking for C++ namespace, need to look further
8065 			     * back.
8066 			     */
8067 			    if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == ourscope)
8068 				continue;
8069 
8070 			    if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0
8071 				    || curwin->w_cursor.lnum
8072 					      < ourscope - FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM)
8073 				break;
8074 
8075 			    l = ml_get_curline();
8076 
8077 			    /* If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip
8078 			     * to the start of it. */
8079 			    trypos = ind_find_start_CORS();
8080 			    if (trypos != NULL)
8081 			    {
8082 				curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
8083 				curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8084 				continue;
8085 			    }
8086 
8087 			    /* Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. */
8088 			    if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
8089 				continue;
8090 
8091 			    /* Finally the actual check for "namespace". */
8092 			    if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l))
8093 			    {
8094 				amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_namespace
8095 							    - added_to_amount;
8096 				break;
8097 			    }
8098 
8099 			    if (cin_nocode(l))
8100 				continue;
8101 			}
8102 		    }
8103 		    break;
8104 		}
8105 
8106 		/*
8107 		 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start
8108 		 * of it.
8109 		 */					    /* XXX */
8110 		if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL)
8111 		{
8112 		    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
8113 		    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8114 		    continue;
8115 		}
8116 
8117 		l = ml_get_curline();
8118 
8119 		/*
8120 		 * If this is a switch() label, may line up relative to that.
8121 		 * If this is a C++ scope declaration, do the same.
8122 		 */
8123 		iscase = cin_iscase(l, FALSE);
8124 		if (iscase || cin_isscopedecl(l))
8125 		{
8126 		    /* we are only looking for cpp base class
8127 		     * declaration/initialization any longer */
8128 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS)
8129 			break;
8130 
8131 		    /* When looking for a "do" we are not interested in
8132 		     * labels. */
8133 		    if (whilelevel > 0)
8134 			continue;
8135 
8136 		    /*
8137 		     *	case xx:
8138 		     *	    c = 99 +	    <- this indent plus continuation
8139 		     *->	   here;
8140 		     */
8141 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM
8142 					   || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
8143 		    {
8144 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8145 			    amount = cont_amount;
8146 			else
8147 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8148 			break;
8149 		    }
8150 
8151 		    /*
8152 		     *	case xx:	<- line up with this case
8153 		     *	    x = 333;
8154 		     *	case yy:
8155 		     */
8156 		    if (       (iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE)
8157 			    || (iscase && lookfor_break)
8158 			    || (!iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL))
8159 		    {
8160 			/*
8161 			 * Check that this case label is not for another
8162 			 * switch()
8163 			 */				    /* XXX */
8164 			if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL
8165 						  || trypos->lnum == ourscope)
8166 			{
8167 			    amount = get_indent();	/* XXX */
8168 			    break;
8169 			}
8170 			continue;
8171 		    }
8172 
8173 		    n = get_indent_nolabel(curwin->w_cursor.lnum);  /* XXX */
8174 
8175 		    /*
8176 		     *	 case xx: if (cond)	    <- line up with this if
8177 		     *		      y = y + 1;
8178 		     * ->	  s = 99;
8179 		     *
8180 		     *	 case xx:
8181 		     *	     if (cond)		<- line up with this line
8182 		     *		 y = y + 1;
8183 		     * ->    s = 99;
8184 		     */
8185 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM)
8186 		    {
8187 			if (n)
8188 			    amount = n;
8189 
8190 			if (!lookfor_break)
8191 			    break;
8192 		    }
8193 
8194 		    /*
8195 		     *	 case xx: x = x + 1;	    <- line up with this x
8196 		     * ->	  y = y + 1;
8197 		     *
8198 		     *	 case xx: if (cond)	    <- line up with this if
8199 		     * ->	       y = y + 1;
8200 		     */
8201 		    if (n)
8202 		    {
8203 			amount = n;
8204 			l = after_label(ml_get_curline());
8205 			if (l != NULL && cin_is_cinword(l))
8206 			{
8207 			    if (theline[0] == '{')
8208 				amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8209 			    else
8210 				amount += curbuf->b_ind_level
8211 						     + curbuf->b_ind_no_brace;
8212 			}
8213 			break;
8214 		    }
8215 
8216 		    /*
8217 		     * Try to get the indent of a statement before the switch
8218 		     * label.  If nothing is found, line up relative to the
8219 		     * switch label.
8220 		     *	    break;		<- may line up with this line
8221 		     *	 case xx:
8222 		     * ->   y = 1;
8223 		     */
8224 		    scope_amount = get_indent() + (iscase    /* XXX */
8225 					? curbuf->b_ind_case_code
8226 					: curbuf->b_ind_scopedecl_code);
8227 		    lookfor = curbuf->b_ind_case_break
8228 					      ? LOOKFOR_NOBREAK : LOOKFOR_ANY;
8229 		    continue;
8230 		}
8231 
8232 		/*
8233 		 * Looking for a switch() label or C++ scope declaration,
8234 		 * ignore other lines, skip {}-blocks.
8235 		 */
8236 		if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE || lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL)
8237 		{
8238 		    if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}')
8239 				     && (trypos = find_start_brace()) != NULL)
8240 		    {
8241 			curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
8242 			curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8243 		    }
8244 		    continue;
8245 		}
8246 
8247 		/*
8248 		 * Ignore jump labels with nothing after them.
8249 		 */
8250 		if (!curbuf->b_ind_js && cin_islabel())
8251 		{
8252 		    l = after_label(ml_get_curline());
8253 		    if (l == NULL || cin_nocode(l))
8254 			continue;
8255 		}
8256 
8257 		/*
8258 		 * Ignore #defines, #if, etc.
8259 		 * Ignore comment and empty lines.
8260 		 * (need to get the line again, cin_islabel() may have
8261 		 * unlocked it)
8262 		 */
8263 		l = ml_get_curline();
8264 		if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)
8265 							     || cin_nocode(l))
8266 		    continue;
8267 
8268 		/*
8269 		 * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or
8270 		 * constructor initialization?
8271 		 */						    /* XXX */
8272 		n = FALSE;
8273 		if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM && curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass > 0)
8274 		{
8275 		    n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&cache_cpp_baseclass);
8276 		    l = ml_get_curline();
8277 		}
8278 		if (n)
8279 		{
8280 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM)
8281 		    {
8282 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8283 			    amount = cont_amount;
8284 			else
8285 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8286 		    }
8287 		    else if (theline[0] == '{')
8288 		    {
8289 			/* Need to find start of the declaration. */
8290 			lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM;
8291 			ind_continuation = 0;
8292 			continue;
8293 		    }
8294 		    else
8295 								     /* XXX */
8296 			amount = get_baseclass_amount(
8297 						cache_cpp_baseclass.lpos.col);
8298 		    break;
8299 		}
8300 		else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS)
8301 		{
8302 		    /* only look, whether there is a cpp base class
8303 		     * declaration or initialization before the opening brace.
8304 		     */
8305 		    if (cin_isterminated(l, TRUE, FALSE))
8306 			break;
8307 		    else
8308 			continue;
8309 		}
8310 
8311 		/*
8312 		 * What happens next depends on the line being terminated.
8313 		 * If terminated with a ',' only consider it terminating if
8314 		 * there is another unterminated statement behind, eg:
8315 		 *   123,
8316 		 *   sizeof
8317 		 *	  here
8318 		 * Otherwise check whether it is a enumeration or structure
8319 		 * initialisation (not indented) or a variable declaration
8320 		 * (indented).
8321 		 */
8322 		terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE);
8323 
8324 		if (js_cur_has_key)
8325 		{
8326 		    js_cur_has_key = 0; /* only check the first line */
8327 		    if (curbuf->b_ind_js && terminated == ',')
8328 		    {
8329 			/* For Javascript we might be inside an object:
8330 			 *   key: something,  <- align with this
8331 			 *   key: something
8332 			 * or:
8333 			 *   key: something +  <- align with this
8334 			 *       something,
8335 			 *   key: something
8336 			 */
8337 			lookfor = LOOKFOR_JS_KEY;
8338 		    }
8339 		}
8340 		if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_JS_KEY && cin_has_js_key(l))
8341 		{
8342 		    amount = get_indent();
8343 		    break;
8344 		}
8345 		if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_COMMA)
8346 		{
8347 		    if (tryposBrace != NULL && tryposBrace->lnum
8348 						    >= curwin->w_cursor.lnum)
8349 			break;
8350 		    if (terminated == ',')
8351 			/* line below current line is the one that starts a
8352 			 * (possibly broken) line ending in a comma. */
8353 			break;
8354 		    else
8355 		    {
8356 			amount = get_indent();
8357 			if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1 == ourscope)
8358 			    /* line above is start of the scope, thus current
8359 			     * line is the one that stars a (possibly broken)
8360 			     * line ending in a comma. */
8361 			    break;
8362 		    }
8363 		}
8364 
8365 		if (terminated == 0 || (lookfor != LOOKFOR_UNTERM
8366 							&& terminated == ','))
8367 		{
8368 		    if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT &&
8369 			    (*skipwhite(l) == '[' || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '['))
8370 			amount += ind_continuation;
8371 		    /*
8372 		     * if we're in the middle of a paren thing,
8373 		     * go back to the line that starts it so
8374 		     * we can get the right prevailing indent
8375 		     *	   if ( foo &&
8376 		     *		    bar )
8377 		     */
8378 		    /*
8379 		     * Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that
8380 		     * matching it will take us back to the start of the line.
8381 		     * Ignore a match before the start of the block.
8382 		     */
8383 		    (void)find_last_paren(l, '(', ')');
8384 		    trypos = find_match_paren(corr_ind_maxparen(&cur_curpos));
8385 		    if (trypos != NULL && (trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum
8386 				|| (trypos->lnum == tryposBrace->lnum
8387 				    && trypos->col < tryposBrace->col)))
8388 			trypos = NULL;
8389 
8390 		    /*
8391 		     * If we are looking for ',', we also look for matching
8392 		     * braces.
8393 		     */
8394 		    if (trypos == NULL && terminated == ','
8395 					      && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}'))
8396 			trypos = find_start_brace();
8397 
8398 		    if (trypos != NULL)
8399 		    {
8400 			/*
8401 			 * Check if we are on a case label now.  This is
8402 			 * handled above.
8403 			 *     case xx:  if ( asdf &&
8404 			 *			asdf)
8405 			 */
8406 			curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
8407 			l = ml_get_curline();
8408 			if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l))
8409 			{
8410 			    ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
8411 			    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8412 			    continue;
8413 			}
8414 		    }
8415 
8416 		    /*
8417 		     * Skip over continuation lines to find the one to get the
8418 		     * indent from
8419 		     * char *usethis = "bla\
8420 		     *		 bla",
8421 		     *      here;
8422 		     */
8423 		    if (terminated == ',')
8424 		    {
8425 			while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
8426 			{
8427 			    l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
8428 			    if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\')
8429 				break;
8430 			    --curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
8431 			    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8432 			}
8433 		    }
8434 
8435 		    /*
8436 		     * Get indent and pointer to text for current line,
8437 		     * ignoring any jump label.	    XXX
8438 		     */
8439 		    if (curbuf->b_ind_js)
8440 			cur_amount = get_indent();
8441 		    else
8442 			cur_amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, &l);
8443 		    /*
8444 		     * If this is just above the line we are indenting, and it
8445 		     * starts with a '{', line it up with this line.
8446 		     *		while (not)
8447 		     * ->	{
8448 		     *		}
8449 		     */
8450 		    if (terminated != ',' && lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM
8451 							 && theline[0] == '{')
8452 		    {
8453 			amount = cur_amount;
8454 			/*
8455 			 * Only add b_ind_open_extra when the current line
8456 			 * doesn't start with a '{', which must have a match
8457 			 * in the same line (scope is the same).  Probably:
8458 			 *	{ 1, 2 },
8459 			 * ->	{ 3, 4 }
8460 			 */
8461 			if (*skipwhite(l) != '{')
8462 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8463 
8464 			if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass && !curbuf->b_ind_js)
8465 			{
8466 			    /* have to look back, whether it is a cpp base
8467 			     * class declaration or initialization */
8468 			    lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS;
8469 			    continue;
8470 			}
8471 			break;
8472 		    }
8473 
8474 		    /*
8475 		     * Check if we are after an "if", "while", etc.
8476 		     * Also allow "   } else".
8477 		     */
8478 		    if (cin_is_cinword(l) || cin_iselse(skipwhite(l)))
8479 		    {
8480 			/*
8481 			 * Found an unterminated line after an if (), line up
8482 			 * with the last one.
8483 			 *   if (cond)
8484 			 *	    100 +
8485 			 * ->		here;
8486 			 */
8487 			if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM
8488 					   || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
8489 			{
8490 			    if (cont_amount > 0)
8491 				amount = cont_amount;
8492 			    else
8493 				amount += ind_continuation;
8494 			    break;
8495 			}
8496 
8497 			/*
8498 			 * If this is just above the line we are indenting, we
8499 			 * are finished.
8500 			 *	    while (not)
8501 			 * ->		here;
8502 			 * Otherwise this indent can be used when the line
8503 			 * before this is terminated.
8504 			 *	yyy;
8505 			 *	if (stat)
8506 			 *	    while (not)
8507 			 *		xxx;
8508 			 * ->	here;
8509 			 */
8510 			amount = cur_amount;
8511 			if (theline[0] == '{')
8512 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8513 			if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM)
8514 			{
8515 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_level
8516 						     + curbuf->b_ind_no_brace;
8517 			    break;
8518 			}
8519 
8520 			/*
8521 			 * Special trick: when expecting the while () after a
8522 			 * do, line up with the while()
8523 			 *     do
8524 			 *	    x = 1;
8525 			 * ->  here
8526 			 */
8527 			l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline());
8528 			if (cin_isdo(l))
8529 			{
8530 			    if (whilelevel == 0)
8531 				break;
8532 			    --whilelevel;
8533 			}
8534 
8535 			/*
8536 			 * When searching for a terminated line, don't use the
8537 			 * one between the "if" and the matching "else".
8538 			 * Need to use the scope of this "else".  XXX
8539 			 * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {".
8540 			 */
8541 			if (cin_iselse(l) && whilelevel == 0)
8542 			{
8543 			    /* If we're looking at "} else", let's make sure we
8544 			     * find the opening brace of the enclosing scope,
8545 			     * not the one from "if () {". */
8546 			    if (*l == '}')
8547 				curwin->w_cursor.col =
8548 					  (colnr_T)(l - ml_get_curline()) + 1;
8549 
8550 			    if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL
8551 				       || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum)
8552 								      == FAIL)
8553 				break;
8554 			}
8555 		    }
8556 
8557 		    /*
8558 		     * If we're below an unterminated line that is not an
8559 		     * "if" or something, we may line up with this line or
8560 		     * add something for a continuation line, depending on
8561 		     * the line before this one.
8562 		     */
8563 		    else
8564 		    {
8565 			/*
8566 			 * Found two unterminated lines on a row, line up with
8567 			 * the last one.
8568 			 *   c = 99 +
8569 			 *	    100 +
8570 			 * ->	    here;
8571 			 */
8572 			if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM)
8573 			{
8574 			    /* When line ends in a comma add extra indent */
8575 			    if (terminated == ',')
8576 				amount += ind_continuation;
8577 			    break;
8578 			}
8579 
8580 			if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
8581 			{
8582 			    /* Found two lines ending in ',', lineup with the
8583 			     * lowest one, but check for cpp base class
8584 			     * declaration/initialization, if it is an
8585 			     * opening brace or we are looking just for
8586 			     * enumerations/initializations. */
8587 			    if (terminated == ',')
8588 			    {
8589 				if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass == 0)
8590 				    break;
8591 
8592 				lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS;
8593 				continue;
8594 			    }
8595 
8596 			    /* Ignore unterminated lines in between, but
8597 			     * reduce indent. */
8598 			    if (amount > cur_amount)
8599 				amount = cur_amount;
8600 			}
8601 			else
8602 			{
8603 			    /*
8604 			     * Found first unterminated line on a row, may
8605 			     * line up with this line, remember its indent
8606 			     *	    100 +
8607 			     * ->	    here;
8608 			     */
8609 			    l = ml_get_curline();
8610 			    amount = cur_amount;
8611 
8612 			    n = (int)STRLEN(l);
8613 			    if (terminated == ',' && (*skipwhite(l) == ']'
8614 					|| (n >=2 && l[n - 2] == ']')))
8615 				break;
8616 
8617 			    /*
8618 			     * If previous line ends in ',', check whether we
8619 			     * are in an initialization or enum
8620 			     * struct xxx =
8621 			     * {
8622 			     *      sizeof a,
8623 			     *      124 };
8624 			     * or a normal possible continuation line.
8625 			     * but only, of no other statement has been found
8626 			     * yet.
8627 			     */
8628 			    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL && terminated == ',')
8629 			    {
8630 				if (curbuf->b_ind_js)
8631 				{
8632 				    /* Search for a line ending in a comma
8633 				     * and line up with the line below it
8634 				     * (could be the current line).
8635 				     * some = [
8636 				     *     1,     <- line up here
8637 				     *     2,
8638 				     * some = [
8639 				     *     3 +    <- line up here
8640 				     *       4 *
8641 				     *        5,
8642 				     *     6,
8643 				     */
8644 				    if (cin_iscomment(skipwhite(l)))
8645 					break;
8646 				    lookfor = LOOKFOR_COMMA;
8647 				    trypos = find_match_char('[',
8648 						      curbuf->b_ind_maxparen);
8649 				    if (trypos != NULL)
8650 				    {
8651 					if (trypos->lnum
8652 						 == curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1)
8653 					{
8654 					    /* Current line is first inside
8655 					     * [], line up with it. */
8656 					    break;
8657 					}
8658 					ourscope = trypos->lnum;
8659 				    }
8660 				}
8661 				else
8662 				{
8663 				    lookfor = LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT;
8664 				    cont_amount = cin_first_id_amount();
8665 				}
8666 			    }
8667 			    else
8668 			    {
8669 				if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL
8670 					&& *l != NUL
8671 					&& l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\')
8672 								/* XXX */
8673 				    cont_amount = cin_get_equal_amount(
8674 						       curwin->w_cursor.lnum);
8675 				if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM
8676 						&& lookfor != LOOKFOR_JS_KEY
8677 						&& lookfor != LOOKFOR_COMMA)
8678 				    lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM;
8679 			    }
8680 			}
8681 		    }
8682 		}
8683 
8684 		/*
8685 		 * Check if we are after a while (cond);
8686 		 * If so: Ignore until the matching "do".
8687 		 */
8688 		else if (cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated)) /* XXX */
8689 		{
8690 		    /*
8691 		     * Found an unterminated line after a while ();, line up
8692 		     * with the last one.
8693 		     *	    while (cond);
8694 		     *	    100 +		<- line up with this one
8695 		     * ->	    here;
8696 		     */
8697 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM
8698 					   || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
8699 		    {
8700 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8701 			    amount = cont_amount;
8702 			else
8703 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8704 			break;
8705 		    }
8706 
8707 		    if (whilelevel == 0)
8708 		    {
8709 			lookfor = LOOKFOR_TERM;
8710 			amount = get_indent();	    /* XXX */
8711 			if (theline[0] == '{')
8712 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8713 		    }
8714 		    ++whilelevel;
8715 		}
8716 
8717 		/*
8718 		 * We are after a "normal" statement.
8719 		 * If we had another statement we can stop now and use the
8720 		 * indent of that other statement.
8721 		 * Otherwise the indent of the current statement may be used,
8722 		 * search backwards for the next "normal" statement.
8723 		 */
8724 		else
8725 		{
8726 		    /*
8727 		     * Skip single break line, if before a switch label. It
8728 		     * may be lined up with the case label.
8729 		     */
8730 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_NOBREAK
8731 				  && cin_isbreak(skipwhite(ml_get_curline())))
8732 		    {
8733 			lookfor = LOOKFOR_ANY;
8734 			continue;
8735 		    }
8736 
8737 		    /*
8738 		     * Handle "do {" line.
8739 		     */
8740 		    if (whilelevel > 0)
8741 		    {
8742 			l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
8743 			if (cin_isdo(l))
8744 			{
8745 			    amount = get_indent();	/* XXX */
8746 			    --whilelevel;
8747 			    continue;
8748 			}
8749 		    }
8750 
8751 		    /*
8752 		     * Found a terminated line above an unterminated line. Add
8753 		     * the amount for a continuation line.
8754 		     *	 x = 1;
8755 		     *	 y = foo +
8756 		     * ->	here;
8757 		     * or
8758 		     *	 int x = 1;
8759 		     *	 int foo,
8760 		     * ->	here;
8761 		     */
8762 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM
8763 					   || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT)
8764 		    {
8765 			if (cont_amount > 0)
8766 			    amount = cont_amount;
8767 			else
8768 			    amount += ind_continuation;
8769 			break;
8770 		    }
8771 
8772 		    /*
8773 		     * Found a terminated line above a terminated line or "if"
8774 		     * etc. line. Use the amount of the line below us.
8775 		     *	 x = 1;				x = 1;
8776 		     *	 if (asdf)		    y = 2;
8777 		     *	     while (asdf)	  ->here;
8778 		     *		here;
8779 		     * ->foo;
8780 		     */
8781 		    if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM)
8782 		    {
8783 			if (!lookfor_break && whilelevel == 0)
8784 			    break;
8785 		    }
8786 
8787 		    /*
8788 		     * First line above the one we're indenting is terminated.
8789 		     * To know what needs to be done look further backward for
8790 		     * a terminated line.
8791 		     */
8792 		    else
8793 		    {
8794 			/*
8795 			 * position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so
8796 			 * that matching it will take us back to the start of
8797 			 * the line.  Helps for:
8798 			 *     func(asdr,
8799 			 *	      asdfasdf);
8800 			 *     here;
8801 			 */
8802 term_again:
8803 			l = ml_get_curline();
8804 			if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')')
8805 				&& (trypos = find_match_paren(
8806 					   curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
8807 			{
8808 			    /*
8809 			     * Check if we are on a case label now.  This is
8810 			     * handled above.
8811 			     *	   case xx:  if ( asdf &&
8812 			     *			    asdf)
8813 			     */
8814 			    curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
8815 			    l = ml_get_curline();
8816 			    if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l))
8817 			    {
8818 				++curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
8819 				curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8820 				continue;
8821 			    }
8822 			}
8823 
8824 			/* When aligning with the case statement, don't align
8825 			 * with a statement after it.
8826 			 *  case 1: {   <-- don't use this { position
8827 			 *	stat;
8828 			 *  }
8829 			 *  case 2:
8830 			 *	stat;
8831 			 * }
8832 			 */
8833 			iscase = (curbuf->b_ind_keep_case_label
8834 						     && cin_iscase(l, FALSE));
8835 
8836 			/*
8837 			 * Get indent and pointer to text for current line,
8838 			 * ignoring any jump label.
8839 			 */
8840 			amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, &l);
8841 
8842 			if (theline[0] == '{')
8843 			    amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8844 			/* See remark above: "Only add b_ind_open_extra.." */
8845 			l = skipwhite(l);
8846 			if (*l == '{')
8847 			    amount -= curbuf->b_ind_open_extra;
8848 			lookfor = iscase ? LOOKFOR_ANY : LOOKFOR_TERM;
8849 
8850 			/*
8851 			 * When a terminated line starts with "else" skip to
8852 			 * the matching "if":
8853 			 *       else 3;
8854 			 *	     indent this;
8855 			 * Need to use the scope of this "else".  XXX
8856 			 * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {".
8857 			 */
8858 			if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM
8859 				&& *l != '}'
8860 				&& cin_iselse(l)
8861 				&& whilelevel == 0)
8862 			{
8863 			    if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL
8864 				       || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum)
8865 								      == FAIL)
8866 				break;
8867 			    continue;
8868 			}
8869 
8870 			/*
8871 			 * If we're at the end of a block, skip to the start of
8872 			 * that block.
8873 			 */
8874 			l = ml_get_curline();
8875 			if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}') /* XXX */
8876 				     && (trypos = find_start_brace()) != NULL)
8877 			{
8878 			    curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
8879 			    /* if not "else {" check for terminated again */
8880 			    /* but skip block for "} else {" */
8881 			    l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
8882 			    if (*l == '}' || !cin_iselse(l))
8883 				goto term_again;
8884 			    ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
8885 			    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8886 			}
8887 		    }
8888 		}
8889 	    }
8890 	}
8891       }
8892 
8893       /* add extra indent for a comment */
8894       if (cin_iscomment(theline))
8895 	  amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment;
8896 
8897       /* subtract extra left-shift for jump labels */
8898       if (curbuf->b_ind_jump_label > 0 && original_line_islabel)
8899 	  amount -= curbuf->b_ind_jump_label;
8900 
8901       goto theend;
8902     }
8903 
8904     /*
8905      * ok -- we're not inside any sort of structure at all!
8906      *
8907      * This means we're at the top level, and everything should
8908      * basically just match where the previous line is, except
8909      * for the lines immediately following a function declaration,
8910      * which are K&R-style parameters and need to be indented.
8911      *
8912      * if our line starts with an open brace, forget about any
8913      * prevailing indent and make sure it looks like the start
8914      * of a function
8915      */
8916 
8917     if (theline[0] == '{')
8918     {
8919 	amount = curbuf->b_ind_first_open;
8920 	goto theend;
8921     }
8922 
8923     /*
8924      * If the NEXT line is a function declaration, the current
8925      * line needs to be indented as a function type spec.
8926      * Don't do this if the current line looks like a comment or if the
8927      * current line is terminated, ie. ends in ';', or if the current line
8928      * contains { or }: "void f() {\n if (1)"
8929      */
8930     if (cur_curpos.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count
8931 	    && !cin_nocode(theline)
8932 	    && vim_strchr(theline, '{') == NULL
8933 	    && vim_strchr(theline, '}') == NULL
8934 	    && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)":", NULL)
8935 	    && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)",", NULL)
8936 	    && cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum + 1,
8937 			      cur_curpos.lnum + 1)
8938 	    && !cin_isterminated(theline, FALSE, TRUE))
8939     {
8940 	amount = curbuf->b_ind_func_type;
8941 	goto theend;
8942     }
8943 
8944     /* search backwards until we find something we recognize */
8945     amount = 0;
8946     curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos;
8947     while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
8948     {
8949 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum--;
8950 	curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8951 
8952 	l = ml_get_curline();
8953 
8954 	/*
8955 	 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start
8956 	 * of it.
8957 	 */						/* XXX */
8958 	if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL)
8959 	{
8960 	    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1;
8961 	    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
8962 	    continue;
8963 	}
8964 
8965 	/*
8966 	 * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or
8967 	 * constructor initialization?
8968 	 */						    /* XXX */
8969 	n = FALSE;
8970 	if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass != 0 && theline[0] != '{')
8971 	{
8972 	    n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&cache_cpp_baseclass);
8973 	    l = ml_get_curline();
8974 	}
8975 	if (n)
8976 	{
8977 							     /* XXX */
8978 	    amount = get_baseclass_amount(cache_cpp_baseclass.lpos.col);
8979 	    break;
8980 	}
8981 
8982 	/*
8983 	 * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines.
8984 	 */
8985 	if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
8986 	    continue;
8987 
8988 	if (cin_nocode(l))
8989 	    continue;
8990 
8991 	/*
8992 	 * If the previous line ends in ',', use one level of
8993 	 * indentation:
8994 	 * int foo,
8995 	 *     bar;
8996 	 * do this before checking for '}' in case of eg.
8997 	 * enum foobar
8998 	 * {
8999 	 *   ...
9000 	 * } foo,
9001 	 *   bar;
9002 	 */
9003 	n = 0;
9004 	if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL)
9005 		     || (*l != NUL && (n = l[STRLEN(l) - 1]) == '\\'))
9006 	{
9007 	    /* take us back to opening paren */
9008 	    if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')')
9009 		    && (trypos = find_match_paren(
9010 				     curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
9011 		curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
9012 
9013 	    /* For a line ending in ',' that is a continuation line go
9014 	     * back to the first line with a backslash:
9015 	     * char *foo = "bla\
9016 	     *		 bla",
9017 	     *      here;
9018 	     */
9019 	    while (n == 0 && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
9020 	    {
9021 		l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
9022 		if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\')
9023 		    break;
9024 		--curwin->w_cursor.lnum;
9025 		curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
9026 	    }
9027 
9028 	    amount = get_indent();	    /* XXX */
9029 
9030 	    if (amount == 0)
9031 		amount = cin_first_id_amount();
9032 	    if (amount == 0)
9033 		amount = ind_continuation;
9034 	    break;
9035 	}
9036 
9037 	/*
9038 	 * If the line looks like a function declaration, and we're
9039 	 * not in a comment, put it the left margin.
9040 	 */
9041 	if (cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum, 0))  /* XXX */
9042 	    break;
9043 	l = ml_get_curline();
9044 
9045 	/*
9046 	 * Finding the closing '}' of a previous function.  Put
9047 	 * current line at the left margin.  For when 'cino' has "fs".
9048 	 */
9049 	if (*skipwhite(l) == '}')
9050 	    break;
9051 
9052 	/*			    (matching {)
9053 	 * If the previous line ends on '};' (maybe followed by
9054 	 * comments) align at column 0.  For example:
9055 	 * char *string_array[] = { "foo",
9056 	 *     / * x * / "b};ar" }; / * foobar * /
9057 	 */
9058 	if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"};", NULL))
9059 	    break;
9060 
9061 	/*
9062 	 * If the previous line ends on '[' we are probably in an
9063 	 * array constant:
9064 	 * something = [
9065 	 *     234,  <- extra indent
9066 	 */
9067 	if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"[", NULL))
9068 	{
9069 	    amount = get_indent() + ind_continuation;
9070 	    break;
9071 	}
9072 
9073 	/*
9074 	 * Find a line only has a semicolon that belongs to a previous
9075 	 * line ending in '}', e.g. before an #endif.  Don't increase
9076 	 * indent then.
9077 	 */
9078 	if (*(look = skipwhite(l)) == ';' && cin_nocode(look + 1))
9079 	{
9080 	    pos_T curpos_save = curwin->w_cursor;
9081 
9082 	    while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1)
9083 	    {
9084 		look = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum);
9085 		if (!(cin_nocode(look) || cin_ispreproc_cont(
9086 				      &look, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)))
9087 		    break;
9088 	    }
9089 	    if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 0
9090 			    && cin_ends_in(look, (char_u *)"}", NULL))
9091 		break;
9092 
9093 	    curwin->w_cursor = curpos_save;
9094 	}
9095 
9096 	/*
9097 	 * If the PREVIOUS line is a function declaration, the current
9098 	 * line (and the ones that follow) needs to be indented as
9099 	 * parameters.
9100 	 */
9101 	if (cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0))
9102 	{
9103 	    amount = curbuf->b_ind_param;
9104 	    break;
9105 	}
9106 
9107 	/*
9108 	 * If the previous line ends in ';' and the line before the
9109 	 * previous line ends in ',' or '\', ident to column zero:
9110 	 * int foo,
9111 	 *     bar;
9112 	 * indent_to_0 here;
9113 	 */
9114 	if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)";", NULL))
9115 	{
9116 	    l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1);
9117 	    if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL)
9118 		    || (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\'))
9119 		break;
9120 	    l = ml_get_curline();
9121 	}
9122 
9123 	/*
9124 	 * Doesn't look like anything interesting -- so just
9125 	 * use the indent of this line.
9126 	 *
9127 	 * Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that
9128 	 * matching it will take us back to the start of the line.
9129 	 */
9130 	find_last_paren(l, '(', ')');
9131 
9132 	if ((trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL)
9133 	    curwin->w_cursor = *trypos;
9134 	amount = get_indent();	    /* XXX */
9135 	break;
9136     }
9137 
9138     /* add extra indent for a comment */
9139     if (cin_iscomment(theline))
9140 	amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment;
9141 
9142     /* add extra indent if the previous line ended in a backslash:
9143      *	      "asdfasdf\
9144      *		  here";
9145      *	    char *foo = "asdf\
9146      *			 here";
9147      */
9148     if (cur_curpos.lnum > 1)
9149     {
9150 	l = ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum - 1);
9151 	if (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\')
9152 	{
9153 	    cur_amount = cin_get_equal_amount(cur_curpos.lnum - 1);
9154 	    if (cur_amount > 0)
9155 		amount = cur_amount;
9156 	    else if (cur_amount == 0)
9157 		amount += ind_continuation;
9158 	}
9159     }
9160 
9161 theend:
9162     if (amount < 0)
9163 	amount = 0;
9164 
9165 laterend:
9166     /* put the cursor back where it belongs */
9167     curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos;
9168 
9169     vim_free(linecopy);
9170 
9171     return amount;
9172 }
9173 
9174     static int
9175 find_match(lookfor, ourscope)
9176     int		lookfor;
9177     linenr_T	ourscope;
9178 {
9179     char_u	*look;
9180     pos_T	*theirscope;
9181     char_u	*mightbeif;
9182     int		elselevel;
9183     int		whilelevel;
9184 
9185     if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF)
9186     {
9187 	elselevel = 1;
9188 	whilelevel = 0;
9189     }
9190     else
9191     {
9192 	elselevel = 0;
9193 	whilelevel = 1;
9194     }
9195 
9196     curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
9197 
9198     while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > ourscope + 1)
9199     {
9200 	curwin->w_cursor.lnum--;
9201 	curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
9202 
9203 	look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
9204 	if (cin_iselse(look)
9205 		|| cin_isif(look)
9206 		|| cin_isdo(look)			    /* XXX */
9207 		|| cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
9208 	{
9209 	    /*
9210 	     * if we've gone outside the braces entirely,
9211 	     * we must be out of scope...
9212 	     */
9213 	    theirscope = find_start_brace();  /* XXX */
9214 	    if (theirscope == NULL)
9215 		break;
9216 
9217 	    /*
9218 	     * and if the brace enclosing this is further
9219 	     * back than the one enclosing the else, we're
9220 	     * out of luck too.
9221 	     */
9222 	    if (theirscope->lnum < ourscope)
9223 		break;
9224 
9225 	    /*
9226 	     * and if they're enclosed in a *deeper* brace,
9227 	     * then we can ignore it because it's in a
9228 	     * different scope...
9229 	     */
9230 	    if (theirscope->lnum > ourscope)
9231 		continue;
9232 
9233 	    /*
9234 	     * if it was an "else" (that's not an "else if")
9235 	     * then we need to go back to another if, so
9236 	     * increment elselevel
9237 	     */
9238 	    look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
9239 	    if (cin_iselse(look))
9240 	    {
9241 		mightbeif = cin_skipcomment(look + 4);
9242 		if (!cin_isif(mightbeif))
9243 		    ++elselevel;
9244 		continue;
9245 	    }
9246 
9247 	    /*
9248 	     * if it was a "while" then we need to go back to
9249 	     * another "do", so increment whilelevel.  XXX
9250 	     */
9251 	    if (cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
9252 	    {
9253 		++whilelevel;
9254 		continue;
9255 	    }
9256 
9257 	    /* If it's an "if" decrement elselevel */
9258 	    look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline());
9259 	    if (cin_isif(look))
9260 	    {
9261 		elselevel--;
9262 		/*
9263 		 * When looking for an "if" ignore "while"s that
9264 		 * get in the way.
9265 		 */
9266 		if (elselevel == 0 && lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF)
9267 		    whilelevel = 0;
9268 	    }
9269 
9270 	    /* If it's a "do" decrement whilelevel */
9271 	    if (cin_isdo(look))
9272 		whilelevel--;
9273 
9274 	    /*
9275 	     * if we've used up all the elses, then
9276 	     * this must be the if that we want!
9277 	     * match the indent level of that if.
9278 	     */
9279 	    if (elselevel <= 0 && whilelevel <= 0)
9280 	    {
9281 		return OK;
9282 	    }
9283 	}
9284     }
9285     return FAIL;
9286 }
9287 
9288 # if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
9289 /*
9290  * Get indent level from 'indentexpr'.
9291  */
9292     int
9293 get_expr_indent()
9294 {
9295     int		indent;
9296     pos_T	save_pos;
9297     colnr_T	save_curswant;
9298     int		save_set_curswant;
9299     int		save_State;
9300     int		use_sandbox = was_set_insecurely((char_u *)"indentexpr",
9301 								   OPT_LOCAL);
9302 
9303     /* Save and restore cursor position and curswant, in case it was changed
9304      * via :normal commands */
9305     save_pos = curwin->w_cursor;
9306     save_curswant = curwin->w_curswant;
9307     save_set_curswant = curwin->w_set_curswant;
9308     set_vim_var_nr(VV_LNUM, curwin->w_cursor.lnum);
9309     if (use_sandbox)
9310 	++sandbox;
9311     ++textlock;
9312     indent = eval_to_number(curbuf->b_p_inde);
9313     if (use_sandbox)
9314 	--sandbox;
9315     --textlock;
9316 
9317     /* Restore the cursor position so that 'indentexpr' doesn't need to.
9318      * Pretend to be in Insert mode, allow cursor past end of line for "o"
9319      * command. */
9320     save_State = State;
9321     State = INSERT;
9322     curwin->w_cursor = save_pos;
9323     curwin->w_curswant = save_curswant;
9324     curwin->w_set_curswant = save_set_curswant;
9325     check_cursor();
9326     State = save_State;
9327 
9328     /* If there is an error, just keep the current indent. */
9329     if (indent < 0)
9330 	indent = get_indent();
9331 
9332     return indent;
9333 }
9334 # endif
9335 
9336 #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT */
9337 
9338 #if defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(PROTO)
9339 
9340 static int lisp_match __ARGS((char_u *p));
9341 
9342     static int
9343 lisp_match(p)
9344     char_u	*p;
9345 {
9346     char_u	buf[LSIZE];
9347     int		len;
9348     char_u	*word = *curbuf->b_p_lw != NUL ? curbuf->b_p_lw : p_lispwords;
9349 
9350     while (*word != NUL)
9351     {
9352 	(void)copy_option_part(&word, buf, LSIZE, ",");
9353 	len = (int)STRLEN(buf);
9354 	if (STRNCMP(buf, p, len) == 0 && p[len] == ' ')
9355 	    return TRUE;
9356     }
9357     return FALSE;
9358 }
9359 
9360 /*
9361  * When 'p' is present in 'cpoptions, a Vi compatible method is used.
9362  * The incompatible newer method is quite a bit better at indenting
9363  * code in lisp-like languages than the traditional one; it's still
9364  * mostly heuristics however -- Dirk van Deun, [email protected]
9365  *
9366  * TODO:
9367  * Findmatch() should be adapted for lisp, also to make showmatch
9368  * work correctly: now (v5.3) it seems all C/C++ oriented:
9369  * - it does not recognize the #\( and #\) notations as character literals
9370  * - it doesn't know about comments starting with a semicolon
9371  * - it incorrectly interprets '(' as a character literal
9372  * All this messes up get_lisp_indent in some rare cases.
9373  * Update from Sergey Khorev:
9374  * I tried to fix the first two issues.
9375  */
9376     int
9377 get_lisp_indent()
9378 {
9379     pos_T	*pos, realpos, paren;
9380     int		amount;
9381     char_u	*that;
9382     colnr_T	col;
9383     colnr_T	firsttry;
9384     int		parencount, quotecount;
9385     int		vi_lisp;
9386 
9387     /* Set vi_lisp to use the vi-compatible method */
9388     vi_lisp = (vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISP) != NULL);
9389 
9390     realpos = curwin->w_cursor;
9391     curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
9392 
9393     if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) == NULL)
9394 	pos = findmatch(NULL, '[');
9395     else
9396     {
9397 	paren = *pos;
9398 	pos = findmatch(NULL, '[');
9399 	if (pos == NULL || ltp(pos, &paren))
9400 	    pos = &paren;
9401     }
9402     if (pos != NULL)
9403     {
9404 	/* Extra trick: Take the indent of the first previous non-white
9405 	 * line that is at the same () level. */
9406 	amount = -1;
9407 	parencount = 0;
9408 
9409 	while (--curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= pos->lnum)
9410 	{
9411 	    if (linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum))
9412 		continue;
9413 	    for (that = ml_get_curline(); *that != NUL; ++that)
9414 	    {
9415 		if (*that == ';')
9416 		{
9417 		    while (*(that + 1) != NUL)
9418 			++that;
9419 		    continue;
9420 		}
9421 		if (*that == '\\')
9422 		{
9423 		    if (*(that + 1) != NUL)
9424 			++that;
9425 		    continue;
9426 		}
9427 		if (*that == '"' && *(that + 1) != NUL)
9428 		{
9429 		    while (*++that && *that != '"')
9430 		    {
9431 			/* skipping escaped characters in the string */
9432 			if (*that == '\\')
9433 			{
9434 			    if (*++that == NUL)
9435 				break;
9436 			    if (that[1] == NUL)
9437 			    {
9438 				++that;
9439 				break;
9440 			    }
9441 			}
9442 		    }
9443 		}
9444 		if (*that == '(' || *that == '[')
9445 		    ++parencount;
9446 		else if (*that == ')' || *that == ']')
9447 		    --parencount;
9448 	    }
9449 	    if (parencount == 0)
9450 	    {
9451 		amount = get_indent();
9452 		break;
9453 	    }
9454 	}
9455 
9456 	if (amount == -1)
9457 	{
9458 	    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum;
9459 	    curwin->w_cursor.col = pos->col;
9460 	    col = pos->col;
9461 
9462 	    that = ml_get_curline();
9463 
9464 	    if (vi_lisp && get_indent() == 0)
9465 		amount = 2;
9466 	    else
9467 	    {
9468 		char_u *line = that;
9469 
9470 		amount = 0;
9471 		while (*that && col)
9472 		{
9473 		    amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(line, &that, (colnr_T)amount);
9474 		    col--;
9475 		}
9476 
9477 		/*
9478 		 * Some keywords require "body" indenting rules (the
9479 		 * non-standard-lisp ones are Scheme special forms):
9480 		 *
9481 		 * (let ((a 1))    instead    (let ((a 1))
9482 		 *   (...))	      of	   (...))
9483 		 */
9484 
9485 		if (!vi_lisp && (*that == '(' || *that == '[')
9486 						      && lisp_match(that + 1))
9487 		    amount += 2;
9488 		else
9489 		{
9490 		    that++;
9491 		    amount++;
9492 		    firsttry = amount;
9493 
9494 		    while (vim_iswhite(*that))
9495 		    {
9496 			amount += lbr_chartabsize(line, that, (colnr_T)amount);
9497 			++that;
9498 		    }
9499 
9500 		    if (*that && *that != ';') /* not a comment line */
9501 		    {
9502 			/* test *that != '(' to accommodate first let/do
9503 			 * argument if it is more than one line */
9504 			if (!vi_lisp && *that != '(' && *that != '[')
9505 			    firsttry++;
9506 
9507 			parencount = 0;
9508 			quotecount = 0;
9509 
9510 			if (vi_lisp
9511 				|| (*that != '"'
9512 				    && *that != '\''
9513 				    && *that != '#'
9514 				    && (*that < '0' || *that > '9')))
9515 			{
9516 			    while (*that
9517 				    && (!vim_iswhite(*that)
9518 					|| quotecount
9519 					|| parencount)
9520 				    && (!((*that == '(' || *that == '[')
9521 					    && !quotecount
9522 					    && !parencount
9523 					    && vi_lisp)))
9524 			    {
9525 				if (*that == '"')
9526 				    quotecount = !quotecount;
9527 				if ((*that == '(' || *that == '[')
9528 							       && !quotecount)
9529 				    ++parencount;
9530 				if ((*that == ')' || *that == ']')
9531 							       && !quotecount)
9532 				    --parencount;
9533 				if (*that == '\\' && *(that+1) != NUL)
9534 				    amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(
9535 						line, &that, (colnr_T)amount);
9536 				amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(
9537 						line, &that, (colnr_T)amount);
9538 			    }
9539 			}
9540 			while (vim_iswhite(*that))
9541 			{
9542 			    amount += lbr_chartabsize(
9543 						 line, that, (colnr_T)amount);
9544 			    that++;
9545 			}
9546 			if (!*that || *that == ';')
9547 			    amount = firsttry;
9548 		    }
9549 		}
9550 	    }
9551 	}
9552     }
9553     else
9554 	amount = 0;	/* no matching '(' or '[' found, use zero indent */
9555 
9556     curwin->w_cursor = realpos;
9557 
9558     return amount;
9559 }
9560 #endif /* FEAT_LISP */
9561 
9562     void
9563 prepare_to_exit()
9564 {
9565 #if defined(SIGHUP) && defined(SIG_IGN)
9566     /* Ignore SIGHUP, because a dropped connection causes a read error, which
9567      * makes Vim exit and then handling SIGHUP causes various reentrance
9568      * problems. */
9569     signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
9570 #endif
9571 
9572 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
9573     if (gui.in_use)
9574     {
9575 	gui.dying = TRUE;
9576 	out_trash();	/* trash any pending output */
9577     }
9578     else
9579 #endif
9580     {
9581 	windgoto((int)Rows - 1, 0);
9582 
9583 	/*
9584 	 * Switch terminal mode back now, so messages end up on the "normal"
9585 	 * screen (if there are two screens).
9586 	 */
9587 	settmode(TMODE_COOK);
9588 #ifdef WIN3264
9589 	if (can_end_termcap_mode(FALSE) == TRUE)
9590 #endif
9591 	    stoptermcap();
9592 	out_flush();
9593     }
9594 }
9595 
9596 /*
9597  * Preserve files and exit.
9598  * When called IObuff must contain a message.
9599  * NOTE: This may be called from deathtrap() in a signal handler, avoid unsafe
9600  * functions, such as allocating memory.
9601  */
9602     void
9603 preserve_exit()
9604 {
9605     buf_T	*buf;
9606 
9607     prepare_to_exit();
9608 
9609     /* Setting this will prevent free() calls.  That avoids calling free()
9610      * recursively when free() was invoked with a bad pointer. */
9611     really_exiting = TRUE;
9612 
9613     out_str(IObuff);
9614     screen_start();		    /* don't know where cursor is now */
9615     out_flush();
9616 
9617     ml_close_notmod();		    /* close all not-modified buffers */
9618 
9619     for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next)
9620     {
9621 	if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL && buf->b_ml.ml_mfp->mf_fname != NULL)
9622 	{
9623 	    OUT_STR("Vim: preserving files...\n");
9624 	    screen_start();	    /* don't know where cursor is now */
9625 	    out_flush();
9626 	    ml_sync_all(FALSE, FALSE);	/* preserve all swap files */
9627 	    break;
9628 	}
9629     }
9630 
9631     ml_close_all(FALSE);	    /* close all memfiles, without deleting */
9632 
9633     OUT_STR("Vim: Finished.\n");
9634 
9635     getout(1);
9636 }
9637 
9638 /*
9639  * return TRUE if "fname" exists.
9640  */
9641     int
9642 vim_fexists(fname)
9643     char_u  *fname;
9644 {
9645     struct stat st;
9646 
9647     if (mch_stat((char *)fname, &st))
9648 	return FALSE;
9649     return TRUE;
9650 }
9651 
9652 /*
9653  * Check for CTRL-C pressed, but only once in a while.
9654  * Should be used instead of ui_breakcheck() for functions that check for
9655  * each line in the file.  Calling ui_breakcheck() each time takes too much
9656  * time, because it can be a system call.
9657  */
9658 
9659 #ifndef BREAKCHECK_SKIP
9660 # ifdef FEAT_GUI		    /* assume the GUI only runs on fast computers */
9661 #  define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 200
9662 # else
9663 #  define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 32
9664 # endif
9665 #endif
9666 
9667 static int	breakcheck_count = 0;
9668 
9669     void
9670 line_breakcheck()
9671 {
9672     if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP)
9673     {
9674 	breakcheck_count = 0;
9675 	ui_breakcheck();
9676     }
9677 }
9678 
9679 /*
9680  * Like line_breakcheck() but check 10 times less often.
9681  */
9682     void
9683 fast_breakcheck()
9684 {
9685     if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP * 10)
9686     {
9687 	breakcheck_count = 0;
9688 	ui_breakcheck();
9689     }
9690 }
9691 
9692 /*
9693  * Invoke expand_wildcards() for one pattern.
9694  * Expand items like "%:h" before the expansion.
9695  * Returns OK or FAIL.
9696  */
9697     int
9698 expand_wildcards_eval(pat, num_file, file, flags)
9699     char_u	 **pat;		/* pointer to input pattern */
9700     int		  *num_file;	/* resulting number of files */
9701     char_u	***file;	/* array of resulting files */
9702     int		   flags;	/* EW_DIR, etc. */
9703 {
9704     int		ret = FAIL;
9705     char_u	*eval_pat = NULL;
9706     char_u	*exp_pat = *pat;
9707     char_u      *ignored_msg;
9708     int		usedlen;
9709 
9710     if (*exp_pat == '%' || *exp_pat == '#' || *exp_pat == '<')
9711     {
9712 	++emsg_off;
9713 	eval_pat = eval_vars(exp_pat, exp_pat, &usedlen,
9714 						    NULL, &ignored_msg, NULL);
9715 	--emsg_off;
9716 	if (eval_pat != NULL)
9717 	    exp_pat = concat_str(eval_pat, exp_pat + usedlen);
9718     }
9719 
9720     if (exp_pat != NULL)
9721 	ret = expand_wildcards(1, &exp_pat, num_file, file, flags);
9722 
9723     if (eval_pat != NULL)
9724     {
9725 	vim_free(exp_pat);
9726 	vim_free(eval_pat);
9727     }
9728 
9729     return ret;
9730 }
9731 
9732 /*
9733  * Expand wildcards.  Calls gen_expand_wildcards() and removes files matching
9734  * 'wildignore'.
9735  * Returns OK or FAIL.  When FAIL then "num_files" won't be set.
9736  */
9737     int
9738 expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_files, files, flags)
9739     int		   num_pat;	/* number of input patterns */
9740     char_u	 **pat;		/* array of input patterns */
9741     int		  *num_files;	/* resulting number of files */
9742     char_u	***files;	/* array of resulting files */
9743     int		   flags;	/* EW_DIR, etc. */
9744 {
9745     int		retval;
9746     int		i, j;
9747     char_u	*p;
9748     int		non_suf_match;	/* number without matching suffix */
9749 
9750     retval = gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_files, files, flags);
9751 
9752     /* When keeping all matches, return here */
9753     if ((flags & EW_KEEPALL) || retval == FAIL)
9754 	return retval;
9755 
9756 #ifdef FEAT_WILDIGN
9757     /*
9758      * Remove names that match 'wildignore'.
9759      */
9760     if (*p_wig)
9761     {
9762 	char_u	*ffname;
9763 
9764 	/* check all files in (*files)[] */
9765 	for (i = 0; i < *num_files; ++i)
9766 	{
9767 	    ffname = FullName_save((*files)[i], FALSE);
9768 	    if (ffname == NULL)		/* out of memory */
9769 		break;
9770 # ifdef VMS
9771 	    vms_remove_version(ffname);
9772 # endif
9773 	    if (match_file_list(p_wig, (*files)[i], ffname))
9774 	    {
9775 		/* remove this matching files from the list */
9776 		vim_free((*files)[i]);
9777 		for (j = i; j + 1 < *num_files; ++j)
9778 		    (*files)[j] = (*files)[j + 1];
9779 		--*num_files;
9780 		--i;
9781 	    }
9782 	    vim_free(ffname);
9783 	}
9784 
9785 	/* If the number of matches is now zero, we fail. */
9786 	if (*num_files == 0)
9787 	{
9788 	    vim_free(*files);
9789 	    *files = NULL;
9790 	    return FAIL;
9791 	}
9792     }
9793 #endif
9794 
9795     /*
9796      * Move the names where 'suffixes' match to the end.
9797      */
9798     if (*num_files > 1)
9799     {
9800 	non_suf_match = 0;
9801 	for (i = 0; i < *num_files; ++i)
9802 	{
9803 	    if (!match_suffix((*files)[i]))
9804 	    {
9805 		/*
9806 		 * Move the name without matching suffix to the front
9807 		 * of the list.
9808 		 */
9809 		p = (*files)[i];
9810 		for (j = i; j > non_suf_match; --j)
9811 		    (*files)[j] = (*files)[j - 1];
9812 		(*files)[non_suf_match++] = p;
9813 	    }
9814 	}
9815     }
9816 
9817     return retval;
9818 }
9819 
9820 /*
9821  * Return TRUE if "fname" matches with an entry in 'suffixes'.
9822  */
9823     int
9824 match_suffix(fname)
9825     char_u	*fname;
9826 {
9827     int		fnamelen, setsuflen;
9828     char_u	*setsuf;
9829 #define MAXSUFLEN 30	    /* maximum length of a file suffix */
9830     char_u	suf_buf[MAXSUFLEN];
9831 
9832     fnamelen = (int)STRLEN(fname);
9833     setsuflen = 0;
9834     for (setsuf = p_su; *setsuf; )
9835     {
9836 	setsuflen = copy_option_part(&setsuf, suf_buf, MAXSUFLEN, ".,");
9837 	if (setsuflen == 0)
9838 	{
9839 	    char_u *tail = gettail(fname);
9840 
9841 	    /* empty entry: match name without a '.' */
9842 	    if (vim_strchr(tail, '.') == NULL)
9843 	    {
9844 		setsuflen = 1;
9845 		break;
9846 	    }
9847 	}
9848 	else
9849 	{
9850 	    if (fnamelen >= setsuflen
9851 		    && fnamencmp(suf_buf, fname + fnamelen - setsuflen,
9852 						  (size_t)setsuflen) == 0)
9853 		break;
9854 	    setsuflen = 0;
9855 	}
9856     }
9857     return (setsuflen != 0);
9858 }
9859 
9860 #if !defined(NO_EXPANDPATH) || defined(PROTO)
9861 
9862 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK
9863 static int vim_backtick __ARGS((char_u *p));
9864 static int expand_backtick __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pat, int flags));
9865 # endif
9866 
9867 # if defined(MSDOS) || defined(FEAT_GUI_W16) || defined(WIN3264)
9868 /*
9869  * File name expansion code for MS-DOS, Win16 and Win32.  It's here because
9870  * it's shared between these systems.
9871  */
9872 # if defined(DJGPP) || defined(PROTO)
9873 #  define _cdecl	    /* DJGPP doesn't have this */
9874 # else
9875 #  ifdef __BORLANDC__
9876 #   define _cdecl _RTLENTRYF
9877 #  endif
9878 # endif
9879 
9880 /*
9881  * comparison function for qsort in dos_expandpath()
9882  */
9883     static int _cdecl
9884 pstrcmp(const void *a, const void *b)
9885 {
9886     return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1));
9887 }
9888 
9889 # ifndef WIN3264
9890     static void
9891 namelowcpy(
9892     char_u *d,
9893     char_u *s)
9894 {
9895 #  ifdef DJGPP
9896     if (USE_LONG_FNAME)	    /* don't lower case on Windows 95/NT systems */
9897 	while (*s)
9898 	    *d++ = *s++;
9899     else
9900 #  endif
9901 	while (*s)
9902 	    *d++ = TOLOWER_LOC(*s++);
9903     *d = NUL;
9904 }
9905 # endif
9906 
9907 /*
9908  * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or
9909  * directories.  Adds matches to "gap".  Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc.
9910  * Return the number of matches found.
9911  * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting
9912  * at "path[wildoff]".
9913  * Return the number of matches found.
9914  * NOTE: much of this is identical to unix_expandpath(), keep in sync!
9915  */
9916     static int
9917 dos_expandpath(
9918     garray_T	*gap,
9919     char_u	*path,
9920     int		wildoff,
9921     int		flags,		/* EW_* flags */
9922     int		didstar)	/* expanded "**" once already */
9923 {
9924     char_u	*buf;
9925     char_u	*path_end;
9926     char_u	*p, *s, *e;
9927     int		start_len = gap->ga_len;
9928     char_u	*pat;
9929     regmatch_T	regmatch;
9930     int		starts_with_dot;
9931     int		matches;
9932     int		len;
9933     int		starstar = FALSE;
9934     static int	stardepth = 0;	    /* depth for "**" expansion */
9935 #ifdef WIN3264
9936     WIN32_FIND_DATA	fb;
9937     HANDLE		hFind = (HANDLE)0;
9938 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
9939     WIN32_FIND_DATAW    wfb;
9940     WCHAR		*wn = NULL;	/* UCS-2 name, NULL when not used. */
9941 # endif
9942 #else
9943     struct ffblk	fb;
9944 #endif
9945     char_u		*matchname;
9946     int			ok;
9947 
9948     /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */
9949     if (stardepth > 0)
9950     {
9951 	ui_breakcheck();
9952 	if (got_int)
9953 	    return 0;
9954     }
9955 
9956     /* Make room for file name.  When doing encoding conversion the actual
9957      * length may be quite a bit longer, thus use the maximum possible length. */
9958     buf = alloc((int)MAXPATHL);
9959     if (buf == NULL)
9960 	return 0;
9961 
9962     /*
9963      * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard or a ~1.
9964      * Copy it into buf, including the preceding characters.
9965      */
9966     p = buf;
9967     s = buf;
9968     e = NULL;
9969     path_end = path;
9970     while (*path_end != NUL)
9971     {
9972 	/* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will
9973 	 * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */
9974 	if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end))
9975 	    *p++ = *path_end++;
9976 	else if (*path_end == '\\' || *path_end == ':' || *path_end == '/')
9977 	{
9978 	    if (e != NULL)
9979 		break;
9980 	    s = p + 1;
9981 	}
9982 	else if (path_end >= path + wildoff
9983 			 && vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[~", *path_end) != NULL)
9984 	    e = p;
9985 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
9986 	if (has_mbyte)
9987 	{
9988 	    len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end);
9989 	    STRNCPY(p, path_end, len);
9990 	    p += len;
9991 	    path_end += len;
9992 	}
9993 	else
9994 #endif
9995 	    *p++ = *path_end++;
9996     }
9997     e = p;
9998     *e = NUL;
9999 
10000     /* now we have one wildcard component between s and e */
10001     /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard
10002      * component. */
10003     for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p)
10004 	if (rem_backslash(p))
10005 	{
10006 	    STRMOVE(p, p + 1);
10007 	    --e;
10008 	    --s;
10009 	}
10010 
10011     /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */
10012     for (p = s; p < e; ++p)
10013 	if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*')
10014 	    starstar = TRUE;
10015 
10016     starts_with_dot = (*s == '.');
10017     pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE);
10018     if (pat == NULL)
10019     {
10020 	vim_free(buf);
10021 	return 0;
10022     }
10023 
10024     /* compile the regexp into a program */
10025     if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD))
10026 	++emsg_silent;
10027     regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE;		/* Always ignore case */
10028     regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC);
10029     if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD))
10030 	--emsg_silent;
10031     vim_free(pat);
10032 
10033     if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0)
10034     {
10035 	vim_free(buf);
10036 	return 0;
10037     }
10038 
10039     /* remember the pattern or file name being looked for */
10040     matchname = vim_strsave(s);
10041 
10042     /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more
10043      * is following then find matches without any directory. */
10044     if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2
10045 							  && *path_end == '/')
10046     {
10047 	STRCPY(s, path_end + 1);
10048 	++stardepth;
10049 	(void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE);
10050 	--stardepth;
10051     }
10052 
10053     /* Scan all files in the directory with "dir/ *.*" */
10054     STRCPY(s, "*.*");
10055 #ifdef WIN3264
10056 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10057     if (enc_codepage >= 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage)
10058     {
10059 	/* The active codepage differs from 'encoding'.  Attempt using the
10060 	 * wide function.  If it fails because it is not implemented fall back
10061 	 * to the non-wide version (for Windows 98) */
10062 	wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL);
10063 	if (wn != NULL)
10064 	{
10065 	    hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb);
10066 	    if (hFind == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE
10067 			      && GetLastError() == ERROR_CALL_NOT_IMPLEMENTED)
10068 	    {
10069 		vim_free(wn);
10070 		wn = NULL;
10071 	    }
10072 	}
10073     }
10074 
10075     if (wn == NULL)
10076 # endif
10077 	hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb);
10078     ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE);
10079 #else
10080     /* If we are expanding wildcards we try both files and directories */
10081     ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb,
10082 		(*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0);
10083 #endif
10084 
10085     while (ok)
10086     {
10087 #ifdef WIN3264
10088 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10089 	if (wn != NULL)
10090 	    p = utf16_to_enc(wfb.cFileName, NULL);   /* p is allocated here */
10091 	else
10092 # endif
10093 	    p = (char_u *)fb.cFileName;
10094 #else
10095 	p = (char_u *)fb.ff_name;
10096 #endif
10097 	/* Ignore entries starting with a dot, unless when asked for.  Accept
10098 	 * all entries found with "matchname". */
10099 	if ((p[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot)
10100 		&& (matchname == NULL
10101 		  || (regmatch.regprog != NULL
10102 				     && vim_regexec(&regmatch, p, (colnr_T)0))
10103 		  || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD)
10104 		     && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), p, e - s) == 0)))
10105 	{
10106 #ifdef WIN3264
10107 	    STRCPY(s, p);
10108 #else
10109 	    namelowcpy(s, p);
10110 #endif
10111 	    len = (int)STRLEN(buf);
10112 
10113 	    if (starstar && stardepth < 100)
10114 	    {
10115 		/* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to
10116 		 * find matches. */
10117 		STRCPY(buf + len, "/**");
10118 		STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end);
10119 		++stardepth;
10120 		(void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE);
10121 		--stardepth;
10122 	    }
10123 
10124 	    STRCPY(buf + len, path_end);
10125 	    if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end))
10126 	    {
10127 		/* need to expand another component of the path */
10128 		/* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */
10129 		(void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE);
10130 	    }
10131 	    else
10132 	    {
10133 		/* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */
10134 		/* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */
10135 		if (*path_end != 0)
10136 		    backslash_halve(buf + len + 1);
10137 		if (mch_getperm(buf) >= 0)	/* add existing file */
10138 		    addfile(gap, buf, flags);
10139 	    }
10140 	}
10141 
10142 #ifdef WIN3264
10143 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10144 	if (wn != NULL)
10145 	{
10146 	    vim_free(p);
10147 	    ok = FindNextFileW(hFind, &wfb);
10148 	}
10149 	else
10150 # endif
10151 	    ok = FindNextFile(hFind, &fb);
10152 #else
10153 	ok = (findnext(&fb) == 0);
10154 #endif
10155 
10156 	/* If no more matches and no match was used, try expanding the name
10157 	 * itself.  Finds the long name of a short filename. */
10158 	if (!ok && matchname != NULL && gap->ga_len == start_len)
10159 	{
10160 	    STRCPY(s, matchname);
10161 #ifdef WIN3264
10162 	    FindClose(hFind);
10163 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10164 	    if (wn != NULL)
10165 	    {
10166 		vim_free(wn);
10167 		wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL);
10168 		if (wn != NULL)
10169 		    hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb);
10170 	    }
10171 	    if (wn == NULL)
10172 # endif
10173 		hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb);
10174 	    ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE);
10175 #else
10176 	    ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb,
10177 		 (*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0);
10178 #endif
10179 	    vim_free(matchname);
10180 	    matchname = NULL;
10181 	}
10182     }
10183 
10184 #ifdef WIN3264
10185     FindClose(hFind);
10186 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10187     vim_free(wn);
10188 # endif
10189 #endif
10190     vim_free(buf);
10191     vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog);
10192     vim_free(matchname);
10193 
10194     matches = gap->ga_len - start_len;
10195     if (matches > 0)
10196 	qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, (size_t)matches,
10197 						   sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp);
10198     return matches;
10199 }
10200 
10201     int
10202 mch_expandpath(
10203     garray_T	*gap,
10204     char_u	*path,
10205     int		flags)		/* EW_* flags */
10206 {
10207     return dos_expandpath(gap, path, 0, flags, FALSE);
10208 }
10209 # endif /* MSDOS || FEAT_GUI_W16 || WIN3264 */
10210 
10211 #if (defined(UNIX) && !defined(VMS)) || defined(USE_UNIXFILENAME) \
10212 	|| defined(PROTO)
10213 /*
10214  * Unix style wildcard expansion code.
10215  * It's here because it's used both for Unix and Mac.
10216  */
10217 static int	pstrcmp __ARGS((const void *, const void *));
10218 
10219     static int
10220 pstrcmp(a, b)
10221     const void *a, *b;
10222 {
10223     return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1));
10224 }
10225 
10226 /*
10227  * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or
10228  * directories.  Adds matches to "gap".  Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc.
10229  * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting
10230  * at "path + wildoff".
10231  * Return the number of matches found.
10232  * NOTE: much of this is identical to dos_expandpath(), keep in sync!
10233  */
10234     int
10235 unix_expandpath(gap, path, wildoff, flags, didstar)
10236     garray_T	*gap;
10237     char_u	*path;
10238     int		wildoff;
10239     int		flags;		/* EW_* flags */
10240     int		didstar;	/* expanded "**" once already */
10241 {
10242     char_u	*buf;
10243     char_u	*path_end;
10244     char_u	*p, *s, *e;
10245     int		start_len = gap->ga_len;
10246     char_u	*pat;
10247     regmatch_T	regmatch;
10248     int		starts_with_dot;
10249     int		matches;
10250     int		len;
10251     int		starstar = FALSE;
10252     static int	stardepth = 0;	    /* depth for "**" expansion */
10253 
10254     DIR		*dirp;
10255     struct dirent *dp;
10256 
10257     /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */
10258     if (stardepth > 0)
10259     {
10260 	ui_breakcheck();
10261 	if (got_int)
10262 	    return 0;
10263     }
10264 
10265     /* make room for file name */
10266     buf = alloc((int)STRLEN(path) + BASENAMELEN + 5);
10267     if (buf == NULL)
10268 	return 0;
10269 
10270     /*
10271      * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard.
10272      * When EW_ICASE is set every letter is considered to be a wildcard.
10273      * Copy it into "buf", including the preceding characters.
10274      */
10275     p = buf;
10276     s = buf;
10277     e = NULL;
10278     path_end = path;
10279     while (*path_end != NUL)
10280     {
10281 	/* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will
10282 	 * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */
10283 	if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end))
10284 	    *p++ = *path_end++;
10285 	else if (*path_end == '/')
10286 	{
10287 	    if (e != NULL)
10288 		break;
10289 	    s = p + 1;
10290 	}
10291 	else if (path_end >= path + wildoff
10292 			 && (vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[{~$", *path_end) != NULL
10293 			     || (!p_fic && (flags & EW_ICASE)
10294 					     && isalpha(PTR2CHAR(path_end)))))
10295 	    e = p;
10296 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
10297 	if (has_mbyte)
10298 	{
10299 	    len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end);
10300 	    STRNCPY(p, path_end, len);
10301 	    p += len;
10302 	    path_end += len;
10303 	}
10304 	else
10305 #endif
10306 	    *p++ = *path_end++;
10307     }
10308     e = p;
10309     *e = NUL;
10310 
10311     /* Now we have one wildcard component between "s" and "e". */
10312     /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard
10313      * component. */
10314     for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p)
10315 	if (rem_backslash(p))
10316 	{
10317 	    STRMOVE(p, p + 1);
10318 	    --e;
10319 	    --s;
10320 	}
10321 
10322     /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */
10323     for (p = s; p < e; ++p)
10324 	if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*')
10325 	    starstar = TRUE;
10326 
10327     /* convert the file pattern to a regexp pattern */
10328     starts_with_dot = (*s == '.');
10329     pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE);
10330     if (pat == NULL)
10331     {
10332 	vim_free(buf);
10333 	return 0;
10334     }
10335 
10336     /* compile the regexp into a program */
10337     if (flags & EW_ICASE)
10338 	regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE;		/* 'wildignorecase' set */
10339     else
10340 	regmatch.rm_ic = p_fic;	/* ignore case when 'fileignorecase' is set */
10341     if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD))
10342 	++emsg_silent;
10343     regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC);
10344     if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD))
10345 	--emsg_silent;
10346     vim_free(pat);
10347 
10348     if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0)
10349     {
10350 	vim_free(buf);
10351 	return 0;
10352     }
10353 
10354     /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more
10355      * is following then find matches without any directory. */
10356     if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2
10357 							  && *path_end == '/')
10358     {
10359 	STRCPY(s, path_end + 1);
10360 	++stardepth;
10361 	(void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE);
10362 	--stardepth;
10363     }
10364 
10365     /* open the directory for scanning */
10366     *s = NUL;
10367     dirp = opendir(*buf == NUL ? "." : (char *)buf);
10368 
10369     /* Find all matching entries */
10370     if (dirp != NULL)
10371     {
10372 	for (;;)
10373 	{
10374 	    dp = readdir(dirp);
10375 	    if (dp == NULL)
10376 		break;
10377 	    if ((dp->d_name[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot)
10378 		 && ((regmatch.regprog != NULL && vim_regexec(&regmatch,
10379 					     (char_u *)dp->d_name, (colnr_T)0))
10380 		   || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD)
10381 		     && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), dp->d_name, e - s) == 0)))
10382 	    {
10383 		STRCPY(s, dp->d_name);
10384 		len = STRLEN(buf);
10385 
10386 		if (starstar && stardepth < 100)
10387 		{
10388 		    /* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to
10389 		     * find matches. */
10390 		    STRCPY(buf + len, "/**");
10391 		    STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end);
10392 		    ++stardepth;
10393 		    (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE);
10394 		    --stardepth;
10395 		}
10396 
10397 		STRCPY(buf + len, path_end);
10398 		if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end)) /* handle more wildcards */
10399 		{
10400 		    /* need to expand another component of the path */
10401 		    /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */
10402 		    (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE);
10403 		}
10404 		else
10405 		{
10406 		    struct stat sb;
10407 
10408 		    /* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */
10409 		    /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */
10410 		    if (*path_end != NUL)
10411 			backslash_halve(buf + len + 1);
10412 		    /* add existing file or symbolic link */
10413 		    if ((flags & EW_ALLLINKS) ? mch_lstat((char *)buf, &sb) >= 0
10414 						      : mch_getperm(buf) >= 0)
10415 		    {
10416 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
10417 			size_t precomp_len = STRLEN(buf)+1;
10418 			char_u *precomp_buf =
10419 			    mac_precompose_path(buf, precomp_len, &precomp_len);
10420 
10421 			if (precomp_buf)
10422 			{
10423 			    mch_memmove(buf, precomp_buf, precomp_len);
10424 			    vim_free(precomp_buf);
10425 			}
10426 #endif
10427 			addfile(gap, buf, flags);
10428 		    }
10429 		}
10430 	    }
10431 	}
10432 
10433 	closedir(dirp);
10434     }
10435 
10436     vim_free(buf);
10437     vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog);
10438 
10439     matches = gap->ga_len - start_len;
10440     if (matches > 0)
10441 	qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, matches,
10442 						   sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp);
10443     return matches;
10444 }
10445 #endif
10446 
10447 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH)
10448 static int find_previous_pathsep __ARGS((char_u *path, char_u **psep));
10449 static int is_unique __ARGS((char_u *maybe_unique, garray_T *gap, int i));
10450 static void expand_path_option __ARGS((char_u *curdir, garray_T	*gap));
10451 static char_u *get_path_cutoff __ARGS((char_u *fname, garray_T *gap));
10452 static void uniquefy_paths __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pattern));
10453 static int expand_in_path __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u	*pattern, int flags));
10454 
10455 /*
10456  * Moves "*psep" back to the previous path separator in "path".
10457  * Returns FAIL is "*psep" ends up at the beginning of "path".
10458  */
10459     static int
10460 find_previous_pathsep(path, psep)
10461     char_u *path;
10462     char_u **psep;
10463 {
10464     /* skip the current separator */
10465     if (*psep > path && vim_ispathsep(**psep))
10466 	--*psep;
10467 
10468     /* find the previous separator */
10469     while (*psep > path)
10470     {
10471 	if (vim_ispathsep(**psep))
10472 	    return OK;
10473 	mb_ptr_back(path, *psep);
10474     }
10475 
10476     return FAIL;
10477 }
10478 
10479 /*
10480  * Returns TRUE if "maybe_unique" is unique wrt other_paths in "gap".
10481  * "maybe_unique" is the end portion of "((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[i]".
10482  */
10483     static int
10484 is_unique(maybe_unique, gap, i)
10485     char_u	*maybe_unique;
10486     garray_T	*gap;
10487     int		i;
10488 {
10489     int	    j;
10490     int	    candidate_len;
10491     int	    other_path_len;
10492     char_u  **other_paths = (char_u **)gap->ga_data;
10493     char_u  *rival;
10494 
10495     for (j = 0; j < gap->ga_len; j++)
10496     {
10497 	if (j == i)
10498 	    continue;  /* don't compare it with itself */
10499 
10500 	candidate_len = (int)STRLEN(maybe_unique);
10501 	other_path_len = (int)STRLEN(other_paths[j]);
10502 	if (other_path_len < candidate_len)
10503 	    continue;  /* it's different when it's shorter */
10504 
10505 	rival = other_paths[j] + other_path_len - candidate_len;
10506 	if (fnamecmp(maybe_unique, rival) == 0
10507 		&& (rival == other_paths[j] || vim_ispathsep(*(rival - 1))))
10508 	    return FALSE;  /* match */
10509     }
10510 
10511     return TRUE;  /* no match found */
10512 }
10513 
10514 /*
10515  * Split the 'path' option into an array of strings in garray_T.  Relative
10516  * paths are expanded to their equivalent fullpath.  This includes the "."
10517  * (relative to current buffer directory) and empty path (relative to current
10518  * directory) notations.
10519  *
10520  * TODO: handle upward search (;) and path limiter (**N) notations by
10521  * expanding each into their equivalent path(s).
10522  */
10523     static void
10524 expand_path_option(curdir, gap)
10525     char_u	*curdir;
10526     garray_T	*gap;
10527 {
10528     char_u	*path_option = *curbuf->b_p_path == NUL
10529 						  ? p_path : curbuf->b_p_path;
10530     char_u	*buf;
10531     char_u	*p;
10532     int		len;
10533 
10534     if ((buf = alloc((int)MAXPATHL)) == NULL)
10535 	return;
10536 
10537     while (*path_option != NUL)
10538     {
10539 	copy_option_part(&path_option, buf, MAXPATHL, " ,");
10540 
10541 	if (buf[0] == '.' && (buf[1] == NUL || vim_ispathsep(buf[1])))
10542 	{
10543 	    /* Relative to current buffer:
10544 	     * "/path/file" + "." -> "/path/"
10545 	     * "/path/file"  + "./subdir" -> "/path/subdir" */
10546 	    if (curbuf->b_ffname == NULL)
10547 		continue;
10548 	    p = gettail(curbuf->b_ffname);
10549 	    len = (int)(p - curbuf->b_ffname);
10550 	    if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) >= MAXPATHL)
10551 		continue;
10552 	    if (buf[1] == NUL)
10553 		buf[len] = NUL;
10554 	    else
10555 		STRMOVE(buf + len, buf + 2);
10556 	    mch_memmove(buf, curbuf->b_ffname, len);
10557 	    simplify_filename(buf);
10558 	}
10559 	else if (buf[0] == NUL)
10560 	    /* relative to current directory */
10561 	    STRCPY(buf, curdir);
10562 	else if (path_with_url(buf))
10563 	    /* URL can't be used here */
10564 	    continue;
10565 	else if (!mch_isFullName(buf))
10566 	{
10567 	    /* Expand relative path to their full path equivalent */
10568 	    len = (int)STRLEN(curdir);
10569 	    if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) + 3 > MAXPATHL)
10570 		continue;
10571 	    STRMOVE(buf + len + 1, buf);
10572 	    STRCPY(buf, curdir);
10573 	    buf[len] = PATHSEP;
10574 	    simplify_filename(buf);
10575 	}
10576 
10577 	if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL)
10578 	    break;
10579 
10580 # if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS)
10581 	/* Avoid the path ending in a backslash, it fails when a comma is
10582 	 * appended. */
10583 	len = (int)STRLEN(buf);
10584 	if (buf[len - 1] == '\\')
10585 	    buf[len - 1] = '/';
10586 # endif
10587 
10588 	p = vim_strsave(buf);
10589 	if (p == NULL)
10590 	    break;
10591 	((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p;
10592     }
10593 
10594     vim_free(buf);
10595 }
10596 
10597 /*
10598  * Returns a pointer to the file or directory name in "fname" that matches the
10599  * longest path in "ga"p, or NULL if there is no match. For example:
10600  *
10601  *    path: /foo/bar/baz
10602  *   fname: /foo/bar/baz/quux.txt
10603  * returns:		 ^this
10604  */
10605     static char_u *
10606 get_path_cutoff(fname, gap)
10607     char_u *fname;
10608     garray_T *gap;
10609 {
10610     int	    i;
10611     int	    maxlen = 0;
10612     char_u  **path_part = (char_u **)gap->ga_data;
10613     char_u  *cutoff = NULL;
10614 
10615     for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++)
10616     {
10617 	int j = 0;
10618 
10619 	while ((fname[j] == path_part[i][j]
10620 # if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS)
10621 		|| (vim_ispathsep(fname[j]) && vim_ispathsep(path_part[i][j]))
10622 #endif
10623 			     ) && fname[j] != NUL && path_part[i][j] != NUL)
10624 	    j++;
10625 	if (j > maxlen)
10626 	{
10627 	    maxlen = j;
10628 	    cutoff = &fname[j];
10629 	}
10630     }
10631 
10632     /* skip to the file or directory name */
10633     if (cutoff != NULL)
10634 	while (vim_ispathsep(*cutoff))
10635 	    mb_ptr_adv(cutoff);
10636 
10637     return cutoff;
10638 }
10639 
10640 /*
10641  * Sorts, removes duplicates and modifies all the fullpath names in "gap" so
10642  * that they are unique with respect to each other while conserving the part
10643  * that matches the pattern. Beware, this is at least O(n^2) wrt "gap->ga_len".
10644  */
10645     static void
10646 uniquefy_paths(gap, pattern)
10647     garray_T	*gap;
10648     char_u	*pattern;
10649 {
10650     int		i;
10651     int		len;
10652     char_u	**fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data;
10653     int		sort_again = FALSE;
10654     char_u	*pat;
10655     char_u      *file_pattern;
10656     char_u	*curdir;
10657     regmatch_T	regmatch;
10658     garray_T	path_ga;
10659     char_u	**in_curdir = NULL;
10660     char_u	*short_name;
10661 
10662     remove_duplicates(gap);
10663     ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1);
10664 
10665     /*
10666      * We need to prepend a '*' at the beginning of file_pattern so that the
10667      * regex matches anywhere in the path. FIXME: is this valid for all
10668      * possible patterns?
10669      */
10670     len = (int)STRLEN(pattern);
10671     file_pattern = alloc(len + 2);
10672     if (file_pattern == NULL)
10673 	return;
10674     file_pattern[0] = '*';
10675     file_pattern[1] = NUL;
10676     STRCAT(file_pattern, pattern);
10677     pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(file_pattern, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
10678     vim_free(file_pattern);
10679     if (pat == NULL)
10680 	return;
10681 
10682     regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE;		/* always ignore case */
10683     regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING);
10684     vim_free(pat);
10685     if (regmatch.regprog == NULL)
10686 	return;
10687 
10688     if ((curdir = alloc((int)(MAXPATHL))) == NULL)
10689 	goto theend;
10690     mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL);
10691     expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga);
10692 
10693     in_curdir = (char_u **)alloc_clear(gap->ga_len * sizeof(char_u *));
10694     if (in_curdir == NULL)
10695 	goto theend;
10696 
10697     for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++)
10698     {
10699 	char_u	    *path = fnames[i];
10700 	int	    is_in_curdir;
10701 	char_u	    *dir_end = gettail_dir(path);
10702 	char_u	    *pathsep_p;
10703 	char_u	    *path_cutoff;
10704 
10705 	len = (int)STRLEN(path);
10706 	is_in_curdir = fnamencmp(curdir, path, dir_end - path) == 0
10707 					     && curdir[dir_end - path] == NUL;
10708 	if (is_in_curdir)
10709 	    in_curdir[i] = vim_strsave(path);
10710 
10711 	/* Shorten the filename while maintaining its uniqueness */
10712 	path_cutoff = get_path_cutoff(path, &path_ga);
10713 
10714 	/* we start at the end of the path */
10715 	pathsep_p = path + len - 1;
10716 
10717 	while (find_previous_pathsep(path, &pathsep_p))
10718 	    if (vim_regexec(&regmatch, pathsep_p + 1, (colnr_T)0)
10719 		    && is_unique(pathsep_p + 1, gap, i)
10720 		    && path_cutoff != NULL && pathsep_p + 1 >= path_cutoff)
10721 	    {
10722 		sort_again = TRUE;
10723 		mch_memmove(path, pathsep_p + 1, STRLEN(pathsep_p));
10724 		break;
10725 	    }
10726 
10727 	if (mch_isFullName(path))
10728 	{
10729 	    /*
10730 	     * Last resort: shorten relative to curdir if possible.
10731 	     * 'possible' means:
10732 	     * 1. It is under the current directory.
10733 	     * 2. The result is actually shorter than the original.
10734 	     *
10735 	     *	    Before		  curdir	After
10736 	     *	    /foo/bar/file.txt	  /foo/bar	./file.txt
10737 	     *	    c:\foo\bar\file.txt   c:\foo\bar	.\file.txt
10738 	     *	    /file.txt		  /		/file.txt
10739 	     *	    c:\file.txt		  c:\		.\file.txt
10740 	     */
10741 	    short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir);
10742 	    if (short_name != NULL && short_name > path + 1
10743 #if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS)
10744 		    /* On windows,
10745 		     *	    shorten_fname("c:\a\a.txt", "c:\a\b")
10746 		     * returns "\a\a.txt", which is not really the short
10747 		     * name, hence: */
10748 		    && !vim_ispathsep(*short_name)
10749 #endif
10750 		)
10751 	    {
10752 		STRCPY(path, ".");
10753 		add_pathsep(path);
10754 		STRMOVE(path + STRLEN(path), short_name);
10755 	    }
10756 	}
10757 	ui_breakcheck();
10758     }
10759 
10760     /* Shorten filenames in /in/current/directory/{filename} */
10761     for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++)
10762     {
10763 	char_u *rel_path;
10764 	char_u *path = in_curdir[i];
10765 
10766 	if (path == NULL)
10767 	    continue;
10768 
10769 	/* If the {filename} is not unique, change it to ./{filename}.
10770 	 * Else reduce it to {filename} */
10771 	short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir);
10772 	if (short_name == NULL)
10773 	    short_name = path;
10774 	if (is_unique(short_name, gap, i))
10775 	{
10776 	    STRCPY(fnames[i], short_name);
10777 	    continue;
10778 	}
10779 
10780 	rel_path = alloc((int)(STRLEN(short_name) + STRLEN(PATHSEPSTR) + 2));
10781 	if (rel_path == NULL)
10782 	    goto theend;
10783 	STRCPY(rel_path, ".");
10784 	add_pathsep(rel_path);
10785 	STRCAT(rel_path, short_name);
10786 
10787 	vim_free(fnames[i]);
10788 	fnames[i] = rel_path;
10789 	sort_again = TRUE;
10790 	ui_breakcheck();
10791     }
10792 
10793 theend:
10794     vim_free(curdir);
10795     if (in_curdir != NULL)
10796     {
10797 	for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++)
10798 	    vim_free(in_curdir[i]);
10799 	vim_free(in_curdir);
10800     }
10801     ga_clear_strings(&path_ga);
10802     vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog);
10803 
10804     if (sort_again)
10805 	remove_duplicates(gap);
10806 }
10807 
10808 /*
10809  * Calls globpath() with 'path' values for the given pattern and stores the
10810  * result in "gap".
10811  * Returns the total number of matches.
10812  */
10813     static int
10814 expand_in_path(gap, pattern, flags)
10815     garray_T	*gap;
10816     char_u	*pattern;
10817     int		flags;		/* EW_* flags */
10818 {
10819     char_u	*curdir;
10820     garray_T	path_ga;
10821     char_u	*paths = NULL;
10822 
10823     if ((curdir = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL)) == NULL)
10824 	return 0;
10825     mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL);
10826 
10827     ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1);
10828     expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga);
10829     vim_free(curdir);
10830     if (path_ga.ga_len == 0)
10831 	return 0;
10832 
10833     paths = ga_concat_strings(&path_ga, ",");
10834     ga_clear_strings(&path_ga);
10835     if (paths == NULL)
10836 	return 0;
10837 
10838     globpath(paths, pattern, gap, (flags & EW_ICASE) ? WILD_ICASE : 0);
10839     vim_free(paths);
10840 
10841     return gap->ga_len;
10842 }
10843 #endif
10844 
10845 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO)
10846 /*
10847  * Sort "gap" and remove duplicate entries.  "gap" is expected to contain a
10848  * list of file names in allocated memory.
10849  */
10850     void
10851 remove_duplicates(gap)
10852     garray_T	*gap;
10853 {
10854     int	    i;
10855     int	    j;
10856     char_u  **fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data;
10857 
10858     sort_strings(fnames, gap->ga_len);
10859     for (i = gap->ga_len - 1; i > 0; --i)
10860 	if (fnamecmp(fnames[i - 1], fnames[i]) == 0)
10861 	{
10862 	    vim_free(fnames[i]);
10863 	    for (j = i + 1; j < gap->ga_len; ++j)
10864 		fnames[j - 1] = fnames[j];
10865 	    --gap->ga_len;
10866 	}
10867 }
10868 #endif
10869 
10870 static int has_env_var __ARGS((char_u *p));
10871 
10872 /*
10873  * Return TRUE if "p" contains what looks like an environment variable.
10874  * Allowing for escaping.
10875  */
10876     static int
10877 has_env_var(p)
10878     char_u *p;
10879 {
10880     for ( ; *p; mb_ptr_adv(p))
10881     {
10882 	if (*p == '\\' && p[1] != NUL)
10883 	    ++p;
10884 	else if (vim_strchr((char_u *)
10885 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2)
10886 				    "$%"
10887 #else
10888 				    "$"
10889 #endif
10890 					, *p) != NULL)
10891 	    return TRUE;
10892     }
10893     return FALSE;
10894 }
10895 
10896 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR
10897 static int has_special_wildchar __ARGS((char_u *p));
10898 
10899 /*
10900  * Return TRUE if "p" contains a special wildcard character.
10901  * Allowing for escaping.
10902  */
10903     static int
10904 has_special_wildchar(p)
10905     char_u  *p;
10906 {
10907     for ( ; *p; mb_ptr_adv(p))
10908     {
10909 	if (*p == '\\' && p[1] != NUL)
10910 	    ++p;
10911 	else if (vim_strchr((char_u *)SPECIAL_WILDCHAR, *p) != NULL)
10912 	    return TRUE;
10913     }
10914     return FALSE;
10915 }
10916 #endif
10917 
10918 /*
10919  * Generic wildcard expansion code.
10920  *
10921  * Characters in "pat" that should not be expanded must be preceded with a
10922  * backslash. E.g., "/path\ with\ spaces/my\*star*"
10923  *
10924  * Return FAIL when no single file was found.  In this case "num_file" is not
10925  * set, and "file" may contain an error message.
10926  * Return OK when some files found.  "num_file" is set to the number of
10927  * matches, "file" to the array of matches.  Call FreeWild() later.
10928  */
10929     int
10930 gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags)
10931     int		num_pat;	/* number of input patterns */
10932     char_u	**pat;		/* array of input patterns */
10933     int		*num_file;	/* resulting number of files */
10934     char_u	***file;	/* array of resulting files */
10935     int		flags;		/* EW_* flags */
10936 {
10937     int			i;
10938     garray_T		ga;
10939     char_u		*p;
10940     static int		recursive = FALSE;
10941     int			add_pat;
10942     int			retval = OK;
10943 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH)
10944     int			did_expand_in_path = FALSE;
10945 #endif
10946 
10947     /*
10948      * expand_env() is called to expand things like "~user".  If this fails,
10949      * it calls ExpandOne(), which brings us back here.  In this case, always
10950      * call the machine specific expansion function, if possible.  Otherwise,
10951      * return FAIL.
10952      */
10953     if (recursive)
10954 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR
10955 	return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags);
10956 #else
10957 	return FAIL;
10958 #endif
10959 
10960 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR
10961     /*
10962      * If there are any special wildcard characters which we cannot handle
10963      * here, call machine specific function for all the expansion.  This
10964      * avoids starting the shell for each argument separately.
10965      * For `=expr` do use the internal function.
10966      */
10967     for (i = 0; i < num_pat; i++)
10968     {
10969 	if (has_special_wildchar(pat[i])
10970 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK
10971 		&& !(vim_backtick(pat[i]) && pat[i][1] == '=')
10972 # endif
10973 	   )
10974 	    return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags);
10975     }
10976 #endif
10977 
10978     recursive = TRUE;
10979 
10980     /*
10981      * The matching file names are stored in a growarray.  Init it empty.
10982      */
10983     ga_init2(&ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 30);
10984 
10985     for (i = 0; i < num_pat; ++i)
10986     {
10987 	add_pat = -1;
10988 	p = pat[i];
10989 
10990 #ifdef VIM_BACKTICK
10991 	if (vim_backtick(p))
10992 	{
10993 	    add_pat = expand_backtick(&ga, p, flags);
10994 	    if (add_pat == -1)
10995 		retval = FAIL;
10996 	}
10997 	else
10998 #endif
10999 	{
11000 	    /*
11001 	     * First expand environment variables, "~/" and "~user/".
11002 	     */
11003 	    if (has_env_var(p) || *p == '~')
11004 	    {
11005 		p = expand_env_save_opt(p, TRUE);
11006 		if (p == NULL)
11007 		    p = pat[i];
11008 #ifdef UNIX
11009 		/*
11010 		 * On Unix, if expand_env() can't expand an environment
11011 		 * variable, use the shell to do that.  Discard previously
11012 		 * found file names and start all over again.
11013 		 */
11014 		else if (has_env_var(p) || *p == '~')
11015 		{
11016 		    vim_free(p);
11017 		    ga_clear_strings(&ga);
11018 		    i = mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file,
11019 							 flags|EW_KEEPDOLLAR);
11020 		    recursive = FALSE;
11021 		    return i;
11022 		}
11023 #endif
11024 	    }
11025 
11026 	    /*
11027 	     * If there are wildcards: Expand file names and add each match to
11028 	     * the list.  If there is no match, and EW_NOTFOUND is given, add
11029 	     * the pattern.
11030 	     * If there are no wildcards: Add the file name if it exists or
11031 	     * when EW_NOTFOUND is given.
11032 	     */
11033 	    if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(p))
11034 	    {
11035 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH)
11036 		if ((flags & EW_PATH)
11037 			&& !mch_isFullName(p)
11038 			&& !(p[0] == '.'
11039 			    && (vim_ispathsep(p[1])
11040 				|| (p[1] == '.' && vim_ispathsep(p[2]))))
11041 		   )
11042 		{
11043 		    /* :find completion where 'path' is used.
11044 		     * Recursiveness is OK here. */
11045 		    recursive = FALSE;
11046 		    add_pat = expand_in_path(&ga, p, flags);
11047 		    recursive = TRUE;
11048 		    did_expand_in_path = TRUE;
11049 		}
11050 		else
11051 #endif
11052 		    add_pat = mch_expandpath(&ga, p, flags);
11053 	    }
11054 	}
11055 
11056 	if (add_pat == -1 || (add_pat == 0 && (flags & EW_NOTFOUND)))
11057 	{
11058 	    char_u	*t = backslash_halve_save(p);
11059 
11060 #if defined(MACOS_CLASSIC)
11061 	    slash_to_colon(t);
11062 #endif
11063 	    /* When EW_NOTFOUND is used, always add files and dirs.  Makes
11064 	     * "vim c:/" work. */
11065 	    if (flags & EW_NOTFOUND)
11066 		addfile(&ga, t, flags | EW_DIR | EW_FILE);
11067 	    else if (mch_getperm(t) >= 0)
11068 		addfile(&ga, t, flags);
11069 	    vim_free(t);
11070 	}
11071 
11072 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH)
11073 	if (did_expand_in_path && ga.ga_len > 0 && (flags & EW_PATH))
11074 	    uniquefy_paths(&ga, p);
11075 #endif
11076 	if (p != pat[i])
11077 	    vim_free(p);
11078     }
11079 
11080     *num_file = ga.ga_len;
11081     *file = (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? (char_u **)ga.ga_data : (char_u **)"";
11082 
11083     recursive = FALSE;
11084 
11085     return (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? retval : FAIL;
11086 }
11087 
11088 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK
11089 
11090 /*
11091  * Return TRUE if we can expand this backtick thing here.
11092  */
11093     static int
11094 vim_backtick(p)
11095     char_u	*p;
11096 {
11097     return (*p == '`' && *(p + 1) != NUL && *(p + STRLEN(p) - 1) == '`');
11098 }
11099 
11100 /*
11101  * Expand an item in `backticks` by executing it as a command.
11102  * Currently only works when pat[] starts and ends with a `.
11103  * Returns number of file names found, -1 if an error is encountered.
11104  */
11105     static int
11106 expand_backtick(gap, pat, flags)
11107     garray_T	*gap;
11108     char_u	*pat;
11109     int		flags;	/* EW_* flags */
11110 {
11111     char_u	*p;
11112     char_u	*cmd;
11113     char_u	*buffer;
11114     int		cnt = 0;
11115     int		i;
11116 
11117     /* Create the command: lop off the backticks. */
11118     cmd = vim_strnsave(pat + 1, (int)STRLEN(pat) - 2);
11119     if (cmd == NULL)
11120 	return -1;
11121 
11122 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
11123     if (*cmd == '=')	    /* `={expr}`: Expand expression */
11124 	buffer = eval_to_string(cmd + 1, &p, TRUE);
11125     else
11126 #endif
11127 	buffer = get_cmd_output(cmd, NULL,
11128 				(flags & EW_SILENT) ? SHELL_SILENT : 0, NULL);
11129     vim_free(cmd);
11130     if (buffer == NULL)
11131 	return -1;
11132 
11133     cmd = buffer;
11134     while (*cmd != NUL)
11135     {
11136 	cmd = skipwhite(cmd);		/* skip over white space */
11137 	p = cmd;
11138 	while (*p != NUL && *p != '\r' && *p != '\n') /* skip over entry */
11139 	    ++p;
11140 	/* add an entry if it is not empty */
11141 	if (p > cmd)
11142 	{
11143 	    i = *p;
11144 	    *p = NUL;
11145 	    addfile(gap, cmd, flags);
11146 	    *p = i;
11147 	    ++cnt;
11148 	}
11149 	cmd = p;
11150 	while (*cmd != NUL && (*cmd == '\r' || *cmd == '\n'))
11151 	    ++cmd;
11152     }
11153 
11154     vim_free(buffer);
11155     return cnt;
11156 }
11157 # endif /* VIM_BACKTICK */
11158 
11159 /*
11160  * Add a file to a file list.  Accepted flags:
11161  * EW_DIR	add directories
11162  * EW_FILE	add files
11163  * EW_EXEC	add executable files
11164  * EW_NOTFOUND	add even when it doesn't exist
11165  * EW_ADDSLASH	add slash after directory name
11166  * EW_ALLLINKS	add symlink also when the referred file does not exist
11167  */
11168     void
11169 addfile(gap, f, flags)
11170     garray_T	*gap;
11171     char_u	*f;	/* filename */
11172     int		flags;
11173 {
11174     char_u	*p;
11175     int		isdir;
11176     struct stat sb;
11177 
11178     /* if the file/dir/link doesn't exist, may not add it */
11179     if (!(flags & EW_NOTFOUND) && ((flags & EW_ALLLINKS)
11180 			? mch_lstat((char *)f, &sb) < 0 : mch_getperm(f) < 0))
11181 	return;
11182 
11183 #ifdef FNAME_ILLEGAL
11184     /* if the file/dir contains illegal characters, don't add it */
11185     if (vim_strpbrk(f, (char_u *)FNAME_ILLEGAL) != NULL)
11186 	return;
11187 #endif
11188 
11189     isdir = mch_isdir(f);
11190     if ((isdir && !(flags & EW_DIR)) || (!isdir && !(flags & EW_FILE)))
11191 	return;
11192 
11193     /* If the file isn't executable, may not add it.  Do accept directories.
11194      * When invoked from expand_shellcmd() do not use $PATH. */
11195     if (!isdir && (flags & EW_EXEC)
11196 			     && !mch_can_exe(f, NULL, !(flags & EW_SHELLCMD)))
11197 	return;
11198 
11199     /* Make room for another item in the file list. */
11200     if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL)
11201 	return;
11202 
11203     p = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(f) + 1 + isdir));
11204     if (p == NULL)
11205 	return;
11206 
11207     STRCPY(p, f);
11208 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME
11209     slash_adjust(p);
11210 #endif
11211     /*
11212      * Append a slash or backslash after directory names if none is present.
11213      */
11214 #ifndef DONT_ADD_PATHSEP_TO_DIR
11215     if (isdir && (flags & EW_ADDSLASH))
11216 	add_pathsep(p);
11217 #endif
11218     ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p;
11219 }
11220 #endif /* !NO_EXPANDPATH */
11221 
11222 #if defined(VIM_BACKTICK) || defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
11223 
11224 #ifndef SEEK_SET
11225 # define SEEK_SET 0
11226 #endif
11227 #ifndef SEEK_END
11228 # define SEEK_END 2
11229 #endif
11230 
11231 /*
11232  * Get the stdout of an external command.
11233  * If "ret_len" is NULL replace NUL characters with NL.  When "ret_len" is not
11234  * NULL store the length there.
11235  * Returns an allocated string, or NULL for error.
11236  */
11237     char_u *
11238 get_cmd_output(cmd, infile, flags, ret_len)
11239     char_u	*cmd;
11240     char_u	*infile;	/* optional input file name */
11241     int		flags;		/* can be SHELL_SILENT */
11242     int		*ret_len;
11243 {
11244     char_u	*tempname;
11245     char_u	*command;
11246     char_u	*buffer = NULL;
11247     int		len;
11248     int		i = 0;
11249     FILE	*fd;
11250 
11251     if (check_restricted() || check_secure())
11252 	return NULL;
11253 
11254     /* get a name for the temp file */
11255     if ((tempname = vim_tempname('o', FALSE)) == NULL)
11256     {
11257 	EMSG(_(e_notmp));
11258 	return NULL;
11259     }
11260 
11261     /* Add the redirection stuff */
11262     command = make_filter_cmd(cmd, infile, tempname);
11263     if (command == NULL)
11264 	goto done;
11265 
11266     /*
11267      * Call the shell to execute the command (errors are ignored).
11268      * Don't check timestamps here.
11269      */
11270     ++no_check_timestamps;
11271     call_shell(command, SHELL_DOOUT | SHELL_EXPAND | flags);
11272     --no_check_timestamps;
11273 
11274     vim_free(command);
11275 
11276     /*
11277      * read the names from the file into memory
11278      */
11279 # ifdef VMS
11280     /* created temporary file is not always readable as binary */
11281     fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, "r");
11282 # else
11283     fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, READBIN);
11284 # endif
11285 
11286     if (fd == NULL)
11287     {
11288 	EMSG2(_(e_notopen), tempname);
11289 	goto done;
11290     }
11291 
11292     fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_END);
11293     len = ftell(fd);		    /* get size of temp file */
11294     fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_SET);
11295 
11296     buffer = alloc(len + 1);
11297     if (buffer != NULL)
11298 	i = (int)fread((char *)buffer, (size_t)1, (size_t)len, fd);
11299     fclose(fd);
11300     mch_remove(tempname);
11301     if (buffer == NULL)
11302 	goto done;
11303 #ifdef VMS
11304     len = i;	/* VMS doesn't give us what we asked for... */
11305 #endif
11306     if (i != len)
11307     {
11308 	EMSG2(_(e_notread), tempname);
11309 	vim_free(buffer);
11310 	buffer = NULL;
11311     }
11312     else if (ret_len == NULL)
11313     {
11314 	/* Change NUL into SOH, otherwise the string is truncated. */
11315 	for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
11316 	    if (buffer[i] == NUL)
11317 		buffer[i] = 1;
11318 
11319 	buffer[len] = NUL;	/* make sure the buffer is terminated */
11320     }
11321     else
11322 	*ret_len = len;
11323 
11324 done:
11325     vim_free(tempname);
11326     return buffer;
11327 }
11328 #endif
11329 
11330 /*
11331  * Free the list of files returned by expand_wildcards() or other expansion
11332  * functions.
11333  */
11334     void
11335 FreeWild(count, files)
11336     int	    count;
11337     char_u  **files;
11338 {
11339     if (count <= 0 || files == NULL)
11340 	return;
11341 #if defined(__EMX__) && defined(__ALWAYS_HAS_TRAILING_NULL_POINTER) /* XXX */
11342     /*
11343      * Is this still OK for when other functions than expand_wildcards() have
11344      * been used???
11345      */
11346     _fnexplodefree((char **)files);
11347 #else
11348     while (count--)
11349 	vim_free(files[count]);
11350     vim_free(files);
11351 #endif
11352 }
11353 
11354 /*
11355  * Return TRUE when need to go to Insert mode because of 'insertmode'.
11356  * Don't do this when still processing a command or a mapping.
11357  * Don't do this when inside a ":normal" command.
11358  */
11359     int
11360 goto_im()
11361 {
11362     return (p_im && stuff_empty() && typebuf_typed());
11363 }
11364 
11365 /*
11366  * Returns the isolated name of the shell in allocated memory:
11367  * - Skip beyond any path.  E.g., "/usr/bin/csh -f" -> "csh -f".
11368  * - Remove any argument.  E.g., "csh -f" -> "csh".
11369  * But don't allow a space in the path, so that this works:
11370  *   "/usr/bin/csh --rcfile ~/.cshrc"
11371  * But don't do that for Windows, it's common to have a space in the path.
11372  */
11373     char_u *
11374 get_isolated_shell_name()
11375 {
11376     char_u *p;
11377 
11378 #ifdef WIN3264
11379     p = gettail(p_sh);
11380     p = vim_strnsave(p, (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p));
11381 #else
11382     p = skiptowhite(p_sh);
11383     if (*p == NUL)
11384     {
11385 	/* No white space, use the tail. */
11386 	p = vim_strsave(gettail(p_sh));
11387     }
11388     else
11389     {
11390 	char_u  *p1, *p2;
11391 
11392 	/* Find the last path separator before the space. */
11393 	p1 = p_sh;
11394 	for (p2 = p_sh; p2 < p; mb_ptr_adv(p2))
11395 	    if (vim_ispathsep(*p2))
11396 		p1 = p2 + 1;
11397 	p = vim_strnsave(p1, (int)(p - p1));
11398     }
11399 #endif
11400     return p;
11401 }
11402